Fanuc Fapt Ladder II Operator
Fanuc Fapt Ladder II Operator
Fanuc Fapt Ladder II Operator
FAPT LADDER - II
Operators Manual
B- 66184EN/02 April 1998
GFLE-003
In this manual we have tried as much as possible to describe all the various matters. However, we cannot describe all the matters which must not be done, or which cannot be done, because there are so many possibilities. Therefore, matters which are not especially described as possible in this manual should be regarded as impossible.
Notice
This document is based on information available at the time of its publication. While efforts have been made to be accurate, the information contained herein does not purport to cover all details or variations in hardware or software, nor to provide every contingency in connection with installation, operation, or maintenance. Features may be described herein which are not present in all hardware and software systems. GE Fanuc Automation assumes no obligation of notice to holders of this document with respect to changes subsequently made. GE Fanuc Automation makes no representation or warranty, expressed, implied, or statutory with respect to, and assumes no responsibility for accuracy, completeness, sufficiency, or usefulness of the information contained herein. No warranties of merchantability or fitness for purpose shall apply. The following are Registered Trademarks of GE Fanuc Automation CIMPLICITY Genius
The following are Trademarks of GE Fanuc Automation Alarm Master CIMSTAR Field Control Genet Helpmate LogicMaster Modelmaster PowerMotion ProLoop PROMACRO Series Five Series 90 Series One Series Six Series Three VuMaster Workmaster
Copyright 1998 FANUC Ltd. Authorized Reproduction GE Fanuc Automation Europe S.A.
All Rights Reserved No part of this manual may be reproduced in any form. All specifications and designs are subject to change without notice.
[Notice] 1. The FAPT LADDER-II software is copyrighted by FANUC Ltd. 2. No part of the software or this manual may be used or reproduced in any form without the prior consent of FANUC Ltd. 3. The software shall be installed on no more than one computer at a time. Separate software packages must be purchased for each additional installation. 4. The information in this manual is subject to change without notice.
[Trademarks] 1. MS-DOS is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation. 2. PC/AT and PS/2 are registered trademarks of International Business Machines Corporation. 3. PR2OlH is a registered trademark of NEC Corporation. 4. VP1000 is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation.
In this manual we have tried as much as possible to describe all the various matters. However, we cannot describe all the matters which must not be done, or which cannot be done, because there are so many possibilities. Therefore, matters which are not especially described as possible in this manual should be regarded as impossible.
CONTENTS
1.
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . .
. . .
. . . . . . . .
. .. . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . .
Program
. . . . . . .. . . . . .
FUNCTIONS
. . . .
to Make a Sequence
1.3
. . . . .
Method Data
. . . . . .
. .
& Comment
2.
ENVIRONMENT SYS
. . .
. .
3.
OF PACAGE
. . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . .
. . .
13 13 13 14
OF PACAGE
.................
AFTER INSTALLATION
............................
CONFIGURATION
. . . . . . .
....................... .........................
of Source Program
14 14
........ .
. . .. . .
. . .
. . . .
16
4.
17 17
. . .
. .. . . . .
20 20 22 25 25
4.3 4.4
COMMON
OPERATIONS
INITIAL MENU 4.4.1 4.4.2 4.4.3 4.4.4 4.4.5 4.4.6 Program Off-Line On-Line On-Line Utility
..................
Selection Function Functron Function
. .. . . . . . .
. . . . . ,. . .. . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
26 27 27 27
Termination FUNCTION
27 28 28 28
4.5
.............................. Editing
.......................... ...............
sequence ediling edrting diagram/step & comment edrlrng editing
30 32 87 92
............... .........
editing
94 97
parameter
4.53 453.1
Printout
................................................
........................................... and ending item setting printing
.............................. ............................
file)
....................................
menu format-2
SETUP output
DAT/
.INF/message specification
.......................
112 123 124 125 128 129 131 132 133 136 137 138 138 140 142
4.5.3.6 4.5.4
Changing
the printer
..........................
Compilation
set function
............................................
........................................... option
...................................... ...................................
Input/Output
............................................. .......................................
FA writer) (PMC writer,
........................ . .
...............................
computer format) and memory card
.................
.................................
Setting
Program
....................................
158 159
Mnemonic
Editing
.........................................
of a source program to a mnemonic file of a mnemonic file to a source program
file format
mnemonic mnemonic
The note if the step sequence when setting a model file execution
function
User batch
.................................................
On-Line Function from Off-Line Function
Selecting
180 181
................................ ..............................
.............................................
Preparation
..............................................
the cable
4.6.2.1
Connecting
...................................
screen
for on-line
monitor
..................
function function
.
.
.............................
the on-line the on-line monitor monitor
.........
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . .
Mate-H)
..........................
195 196 196 198 198 200 201 215 216 218 231 232
............................................. Fitesave Selecting Exit ...................................... off-line function from on-line functron
...........
. . . . . .
.........................................
Diagnose Ladder
.........................................
monitor
window
Status window
................................. ................
or stopping system
. . . . . . . .
. . . .
information
.......................
. . . a 233
234 234 235 236 238 240 240 252
.......................................
from the PMC to the PMC to F-ROM
............................
. . . .
Communication Examples
.....................................
a ladder a ladder
of Operation
4.6.7.1 4.6.7.2
Monitoring Monitoring
...........
computer
. . ... . . . . . . . .
5.
ERROR 5.1 A:
MESSAGE INITIAL
LIST
MENU
. .
. . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . .
.................... ..........................
EDITING
5.3
..
....................... ........................
EDITING
5.4
PARAMETER
......
...................
EDITING
5.5
SEQUENCE
...............
Ladder
. .
. .
(at Editing
5.6
8, COMMENT
EDITING
.......... . . .
. . . .
..........................
EDITING
5.7
................... ....................
....
I.
BASICS
(NORMAL OPERATIONS) .
,,,,,, ,,,
,,
,,,
,,,
1. GENERAL
1.
GENERAL
1.1 Overview
Thank you for purchasing FANUC FAPT LADDER-II.
is a programming to operate
system
for developing
FANUC
is designed
on IBM PC/AT
and English
languages.
of the operating
Personal
computer
both supported
explains
procedures designed
required
to install,
activate,
and operate
this software
about
that
to the system
T FANUC Programming
PMC-MODEL manual
PAl/PAB/RAl/RA2/RA3/RB/RB2/RB3/RB4/RBS/RBG/RC/RC3/RC4/NB/NB2 language)
(LADDER
J B-61 863E
Inquiry
form after reading at Appendix this operators 9 to consult manual and the manuals listed above,
form attached
us the questions.
-l-
1. GENERAL
The following
abbreviations
1)
Abbreviations PMC-R Series PMCRA3 FANUC FANUC FANUC FANUC FANUC FANUC FANUC FANUC FANUC FANUC FANUC
PMC Models
PMC-MODEL PMC-MODEL PMC-MODEL PMC-MODEL PMC-MODEL PMC-MODEL PMC-MODEL PMC-MODEL PMC-MODEL PMC-MODEL PMC-MODEL
. PMCRB3
PMCRB4 PMCRB5 PMC-RB6 PMCRC3
PMCRC4
2) Others
MS-DOS between and PC-DOS are both referred systems. to simply as DOS, unless it is necessary to distinguish the two operating
-2-
1. GENERAL
. . . .. .. .. . . .. . . .. .. . .
L
...)
CNC
(..........
Machine DVDO
Tool
RS-232-C
PMC
RS-232-C
.,.,,.. . ...
functions through RS-232-C (Note 1) Monitorring & debugging a sequence program Run/Stop a sequence program Transferring a sequence program Write to Flash ROM I Setting and display PMC parameters
(INLINE
computer
IBM PC/AT
Hard disk
Fig. 1.2.1
General
of PMC Function
Note 1)
functions
may vary
from
one
PMC
model
to another. of each
with some
models.
For details
function,
being used.
-3-
,,
,,
1. GENERAL
< Functions
of ladder
. . .
c PMC built-in
functions
> and Edtt sequence of sequence program program ladder diagram, PMC alarm, memory)
Display
signal waveforms,
(and crossreference.) (Monitorring Setting of ladder diagram, step sequence. Debugging user C language.)
and display
Run/Stop
the sequence
1.2.2
PMC models
PMC-RA3 PMCRB3 PMCRB4 PMC-RB5 PMC-RB6 PMCRC3 PMCRC4 PMC-PA3 PMC-QC PMC-NB PMCNB2 (Note (Note (Note (Note (Note (Note (Note 1) 1) 1)
1)
1) 1) 1)
(Note 1)
ONLINE
function
is supported
-4-
1. GENERAL
program
Start of control system development + Decrde the control object (machines, t Decide the specifications of control operations Calculate the number of DVOO points Estrmate the control scale CNC)
addoress mapcoading)
t
FAPT LADDER-II 7
t
CNC (PMC)
Compile/Link I
I
fDecompile (1 I I IN0 YES
t
ONLINE
program
supports an off-line function and on-line functions. programming using a personal computer
to the CNC
The off-lrne function IS equrvalent to the FAPT LADDER for programming function. mainly when a connection and communication
function.
The on-line functions are used with the CNC (PMC). program) computer. is available. about FAPT computers) The latter is used
are established
There are basically two on-line functions: the on-line function and the on-line (selected The former is designed to monitor and edit for use wrth CNC (PMC) internal programs. designed to operate on the system, FAPT LADDER IS not covered refer to the FAPT programs personal
Addrtionally. a PMC programming Thus version of FAPT LADDER operators for personal LADDER
by this manual.
computers,
-5-
1. GENERAL
The ladder method is most of ten used for programming This method was derived from relay-panel the number of functions many sequence engineers are already fatiiiiar The greater complicated method. To overcome LADDER-II. (1) What is the step sequence programmable a flow chart. method. method ? this problem, step sequence the sequence program becomes. with it.
implemented
method programming
The step sequence is one of the method for programming Each block of processing is described
a sequence control governed by a of the control flow on using the ladder and is
as a subprogram,
well-suited to the control of entire process. Step sequence method is available to PMC-RB4&lBG/RC4. The programming by step sequence method is supported by FAPT LADDER-II, not but by the builtin editing function on PMC-RB4/RBG/RC4. Setting a model in FAPT LADDER desides witch method, step sequence or ladder, is used. For the details of the step sequence method, refer to the following manual. (4.5.2.2.(3) STEP SEQUENCE EDITING]
-6-
1.
GENERAL
of a sequence
program
The 1st level of ladder The 2nd level of ladder The 3rd level of ladder Subprograms Subprograms of ladder of step sequence
LEVEL 1 ( LADDER)
LEVEL 2 ( LADDER)
LEVEL 3 ( LADDER)
ISub Program
Pl (Step Sequence)
. .
Sub Program Pn (Step Sequence)
-7-
1. GENERAL
(3)
-
Data flow
FAPT LADDER-II I
IMemory
I t
------I!
Input/Output
I
Input/Output
I
RS-232-C
CNC V v V
[PMCI 2) II/O1
1) 3) [HOST]
1) FMCI 2) II01
3) [FDCAS]
1) WC1
2) If/O1 3) [MCARD] (Boot process also can read the memory card)
-8-
1. GENERAL
add notes to a sequence They are generally (1) The definition The definition Terms Symbol
calledsymbol of terms
below
between
some symbol
data.
I
x0.0 +I---,++ them.
to each relay/coil,
INPUT
to be used in place of PMC address. Relay comment Text assigned to relays/coils to explain
Net comment
between
ladder
(2) Symbol
& comment
specification relay
list
I Speciftcation
Available characters
Relay comment
Coil comment ASCII characters Japanese kanalkanji characters (Note 30 byte 20,000
1)
(Note Allowerd
2)
No
Yes, if the symbol assigned to the same address is 6 bytes or (Note shoter replaced to blank. computer may
3)
CRT/MD1 can not display Free area them. When the total size of size of hard
characters, EMS
and XMS
on personal
restrict
all
coil
comments
exceeds
64
kbytes,
no
symbols
and
comments
are displayed
on CRTIMDI.
-9-
1. GENERAL
sequence
program
2 step/Net
comment
1)
(Note 2)
Note Note
1) 2)
which
is reached in each
computer
them.
-lO-
2.
OPERATING
ENVIRONMENT
2.
OPERATING
ENVIRONMENT
the requirements indicated in the table below must be satisfied.
Computer
IBM PC/AT and compatible 386 or hrgher MS-DOS MS-DOS Version Version
machines
(Note
1)
ICPU
IHard
I-Memory disk 1Graphic adapter This software than 520 Kbytes The size CHKDSK.
OS
5.OAlior later (to activate Japanese system) 5.0 or later (to activate English system) (Note 2) (Note 3) (Note 4)
memory 520 Kbytes or more XMS of 4 Mbytes or more (recommended) or more space
machines API
(Note 5)
be in conformity
(Note 1)
(Note
does not run on PC98 series of NEC. has 640 Kbytes memory, the empty memory may not be more space. command
driver, can
in memory
(Note
3) The quantity
Symbol specially Moreover, steps which or more data
of the and
EMS
and
XMS
memory Please
effects
on the enough
to handle memory
Net
comment.
prepare
for Symbol
of large number. than 256 Kbytes, the Please maximum prepare number of
can handle
may be ristricted.
256 Kbytes
EMS rf possible.
(Note (Note
4) In addrtion, an area for storing sequence data is required. PRINTERtare also available by changing 5) [NEC PR201HlandlFANUC
For details, refer 1014.5.3.6 Changing the Printer Specification).
system
file.
About
to be used : and symbol & XMS, & comment data as an temporary and/or XMS area. memory
runs with
enough
size of EMS
to the source
program
to handle
will be necessary
(1)
Expansion When
memory ladder programs, uses FAPT LADDER uses EMS When if available. only If EMS is not is
reading FAPT
available, used,
LADDER program
conventional
memory.
conventional
memory
IS
up to 21840
steps
can be created.
When
256KB
EMS memory
available,
however, models,
up to 32000 regardless
program
to be edited.
-ll-
2.
OPERATING
ENVIRONMENT
(2) EMS and XMS memory for Symbol & Comment data
FAPT LADDER When neither uses EMS and/or XMS memory of them are available, large number FAPT lor Symbol LADDER will & Comment make data if available. file on the hard temporary
diskdrive,
and processing
of Symbol
& Comment
(3)
(1)
ANSI.SYS (required)
The display mode and attributes of the display unit are set. This setting cannot be omitted.
(2)
EMM386.EXE This device another driver enables refer the use of expansion relevant manual memory for as EMS details memory. setting When using in
EMS
driver,
to the
of the
required
CONFIG.SYS.
(3)
MSIME.SYS/MSIMEK.SYS This device using another setting required driver enables the use of MS-KANJI input system, API for Japanese-language manual input. for details When of the
Japanese
language
in CONFIG.SYS. device drivers are provided as standard under with MS-DOS. directory This manual on drive C.
(Note 1)
that these
device
drivers
are placed
the vDOS
of switches
may be required
settings.
(Note
refer
to the manual
required may
(Note
3) Some
problem
is anticipated, device
specify drivers.
in CONFIG.SYS. is specified,
ANSI.SYS
any contention
to be identified
-12-
3. THE CONTENTS
OF PACAGE
AND INSTALLATION
3.
THE CONTENTS
OF PACAGE
AND INSTALLATION
of Pacage
in 5 floppy disks listed below. Please confirm contens.
is stored
size is 3.5 inch 2HD (1.44MB). (Vol. 1)A08B-9201 (Vol. 2)!A08B-9201 (Vol. 3)!A08B-9201 (Vol. 4)!A08B-9201 (Vol. 5)!A08B-9201
FAPT LADDER-II FAPT LADDER-II FAPT LADDER-II FAPT LADDER-II FAPT LADDER-II
3.2 Installation
Install the system the example below using install .exe stored in Vol. 1 of system floppy disk. A:, and directory Y FLADDER
assumes
that a system
[Operation] Set system Execute floppy disk Vol. 1 in the drive A:. exe using the following command.
install.
C: + > A: Y INSTALL After that, go on accordint To select Select changed. the displaying pattern to inquiry color. by of the system below which is inquired when necessry.
the displaying
s display.
Select
color
type.
. 0
COLOR MONO 1
Select
Displaying
Color
Dialog
Box
-13-
If installation
completes,
the message
below
appears.
(Note 1) (Note 2)
To stop installation,
specified
After Installation
the following subdirectories under the specified directory
(C: Y FLADDER
example):
C: Y FLADDER l=zz The messages error indications) The installer function to be displayed are contained by FAPT LADDER-II (such as menus, displayed instructions, and
automatically
creates
is used:
C: Y FLADDER
(Note)
Be careful
not to accidentally
delete
(1)
files can be customized ladder programs, by the user. These functions include setting of the format
created
and communication
port setting
based
on the RS232C
functions,
the These
associated
data
is held
in text-format
files,
which
can
be directly
by the user.
(a) Printing
(For details,
see Section
4.5.3.5.)
. AMROFTRP.DAT
CROSSINF.DAT
-14-
. .INF
(b)Communications (For details. see Section 4.5.6.1.)
. FL10 - AT.DAT
(c)Compile/decompile OPTION.CNF (For details. see Section 4.573.)
(d)Entire
system (For details, (For details, see Section see Section 4.5.8.7.) 4.5.9.)
FLMNE.DAT FLVIEW.DAT
(2)
Other
files
(a)README.TXTIREADMEJ.TXT These printed. Use this information Japanese in combination with the manual. contains English text. Note that READMEJ.TXT contains text files contain important information that became available after the manual was
(b)*.JPN.ENG A file having either of the above extensions contains most of the messages (menus. The
displayed location
instructions.
to be displayed
or printed
by the system.
in Section 3.3.
(c)FLMNE.ERR The results (including errors) of mnemonic conversion are written into this text file.
(d).EXE A file having this extension IS an executable file. Such files are not handled by the user.
(3)
(a)Printing
(For details.
see Section
4.5.3.6.)
. AMROFTRP.ESC . AMROFTRP.PR
(b)Standard symbols SYM SYM (For details. see Appendix 4.)
. PM-C_CNV.
-15-
3. THE CONTENTS
OF PACAGE
AND INSTALLATION
(c)Message
- CHGMES.EXE
3.4.2
In FAPT LADDER-II,
as source program
- SAMPLE.ERR SAMPLE.MAP
result
file
(Note 1) (Note 1)
CONTROL SYSPARAM XSYMBOL.xxx MESSAGE IOMODULE LEVELl. #LA LEVEL2. #LA LEVEL3. #LA Pyyy. #LA Pzzz. #SS NETCMT.xxx MCARD
* * * * * * * - *
Source program managing file System parameter data file Title data file Symbol & Comment data file Message data file I/O module data file 1st level ladder data file 2nd level ladder data file 3rd level ladder data file Sub-program ladder data file Sub-program step sequence data file Net comment data file Memory card format data file
(Note
2)
3) 4) 4) 2)
(Note 1)
These files
are not Included in a source program, but are named in accordance the source program. These files are stored under the directory one level above
the source
program
storage directory.
xxx is number of multi file managing. Only for using LEVEL-3 ladder at PMWRC3IRC4IRC4 (STEP)/NB/NB2/QC.
- 16-
4. OPERATION
4. OPERATION
4.1 Activation
(1) Activation method
01 Move to the drive and directory 0 Key in FLADDER Start FAPT -z Enter > LADDER-II
where
system
software
is installed.
(Example)
when
the
software
is
installed
under
the
\FLADDER
1 shown below,
display while key (Fig. 4.1 (a)). changes
> FLADDER
initial
for 3 seconds,
to the initial
Pressing
screen
is displayed delay.
immediately
the 3second
(Note)
program
is selected,
menu
items
OFF-LINE dotted
PROGRAM)*
are displayed
using
be selected. F A P T LADDER-II Version 01 .O A08B-9201 -J503 Copyright (C) 1991- 1995 FANUC
1
LTD.
I I i I il
II 1 7 II
II II
FAPT LADDER-II Top Screen
FANUC
fnitial
Drw. No. Ver. Press press
[TAB] [ENTER]
menu
.. ..
key
or
to
move
[SPACE]
OWtine On-tine
Fig. 4.1(b)
-17-
4.
OPERATION
(2)
There are two methods line. of returning from the FAPT LADDER-II initial menu screen to the DOS command
Press the < Esc > key while the initial menu Alternatively,select For details menu item END
screen
is displayed.
of selecting
(Note)
FAPT LADDER-II directory Example: can be started more easily by creating a batch file, as described below, under a for which a path IS set. The following software batch file, named FLDDER, is created directory when the FAPT LADDER-II
system
is installed
on drive C:
- 19-
4.
OPERATION
OF OPERATIONS Configuration
of the menu screens displayed by the system are shown below.
The configuration
$
TOP screen -I +
Program
Selection
Off-Line On-Line
Function
(1)
Function
(2)
(3)
Utrlity I I
DOS flOadat View result Linker TITLE PARAMETER SYMBOL LADDER DIAGRAM LADDER DIAGRAM/
L(1)
STEP SEQUENCE SYMBOL MESSAGE I/O MODULE SYSTEM PARAMETER FA WRITER PMC WRITER PMC Handy Memory BACKUP File Card & COMMENT
STEP SEQUENCE
CROSS
REFERENCE MAP
LIST
_ -
BIT ADDRESS
PROGRAM
OPTION
SET-UP
SOURCE
FILE
MNEMONIC EXECUTE
PROGRAM FILE
- 20 -
4.
OPERATION
File save Off-Line Exit Diagnose t Ladder Online Monitor/ Editor Timer Counter Keep relay Data table control Data table Function
(3) 1
On-Line (selected
Function program)
PMC Status Signal Status PMC Parameter PMC alarm RUN/STOP System status the ladder
Information
-21-
4. OPERATION
IF11
WI
key
key
IF31
IF41
WI
WI
if=71
IF81
WI
IF101
(2) Escape
escape
The escape
< ESC>
effect
as selecting
[END]
key.
The in the
key terminates
the current
then returns
the display
screen
menu hierarchy.
(3) Cursor
select
keys
keys < t >,
The cursor
<
1 >, < t
>, and
<
are used
to move
the cursor
to
input items. cursors can be used on a single the <SHIFT> key together screen, the second or subsequent > key. cursor
by pressing
(4) Scroll
The previous
keys
scroll keys <ROLL UP> and <ROLL down DOWN > (to display scroll the screen up (to display respectively
the
(for
one page)
the PC9801). The scroll keys page, respectively <PAGE DOWN > and < PAGE UP > display the next page and the previous
(5) [INS]
(6) [TAB]
key
keys are displayed, press < Tab > key and select one button.
When multipul
-22-
4. OPERATION
Main
menu
PMC-RB3
<o>[c: \FLADDER
t-
t-
Model
currently
selected
Current directory
name
Edit mode
(overwrite/insert)
(Note)
The
indications depending
on the
key
tops
may
slightly
vary
from
the
descnptions
of this
manual,
on the personal
computer
used.
1)
Cursor
movement key < 7 > or < 1 >, such that the item to be selected the <RETURN > key selects that item.
Then, pressing
2)
Function
key key is indicated key. at the left of each item. To select an item, press the
A function corresponding
function
3)
Command
name letter pressing In (usually, the letter the initial of) an item name key < U >, is the command can select name. In the Quit, or
the Update,
command,
respectively.
-23
4. OPERATION
(9) Pull-down
menus
On some screens, the following menu bar is displayed along the top of the screen:
....;
FiM;
:::
,.:.,
2. Diagnose
I
I
3. l/O
I
I
4. Communication
I
I
)
%I&
I 1
Function number. Function name Icon for PMC status indication (See the section explaining how to start the on-line functions.)
Pressing the < Alt > key displays the pull-down menu for ?i Ff@.~v The pull-down menu for a function can also be displayed by pressing the < Alt > key and
the corresponding function number simultaneously.
2. Diagnose I
3. I/O
4. Communication
%lll-
Exit
Using the cursor keys. position the highlight to the desired item on a functions pull-down menu. A menu item with an arrow mark (G) at its right edge has its own pull-down menu, which can be displayed by pressing the < + > key. The target screen is displayed by pressing the < Enter > key after positioning the highlight to a desired menu item.
-24-
4.
OPERATION
4.4
Initial Menu
screen appears when the FAPT LADDER-II system is started. See also Section
upon
chosen
from down be
this menu.
function then
press
<Enter>
spacebar.
4.4.1
When screen system. fi)
Program selection
PROGRAM used SELECT is selected from the initial menu, program the screen with display the switches FAPT to the
to specify
the name
of a source
to be used
LADDER-II
To spectfy
the source
program
name,
enter
drive:vsource-program-name.
the name
of the desired
source
program, without
press Fl changing
(EXEC]
Press
to return
the source
Examples: Specifying SAMPLE as a source [EXEC]. name is specified, the PMC model screen. name and source program name are program under the DATA directory on drive C:
in the upper
program shown
name: below, appears. program, Using the cursor then press the keys, <Enter source move the cursor to the If
for a new
source
[COPY]
without
specifying
a PMC model,
an existing
can be
copied
as a new source
program.
The
FAPT
LADDER-II
system
creates files.
a directory
for the
specified
source
program
name,
and
creates
program
-25-
4. OPERATION
PMC IMC
E;IB -NBZ
SPliTI
Fig. 4.4.1
4.4.2
When
Off-line function
OFF-LINE FUNCTION is selected from the initial menu, the off-line menu screen appears a function equivalent to the FAPT LADDER system
displayed
screen.
This function is used mainly for programming (PMC) has not been established. For
when connection
Fl F2 F3 f1 f5
Ph
EDIT PRINT COMPILE DECOHPIL~ I/O PROGRRH OPIIDN SLIPUP MNEMONIC EDIT UllLllV ON-LINt tUNCllDN
f? tB tY
Fig. 4.4.2
4.
OPERATION
4.4.3
When
On-line function
ON-LINE held FUNCTION by the PMC. is selected Programs from the initial menu, are loaded into the the on-line personal 4.6. function computer is applied by to the of
programs automatic
means
communication
For details,
see Section
4.4.4
When used
program)
is selected from the initial menu, A comparison computer. the on-line is made function is the
on the personal
computer.
between
program select
If a mismatch
is detected,
a monitoring
see Section
4.4.5
When
Utility
UTILITY is selected from the initial menu, a function selection and Linker. menu appears to enable the
View result,
function,
For details
of each function,
see Section
4.4.6
When line.
Termination
END is selected from the initial menu, the screen display returns to the DOS command
-27-
4. OPERATION
F2
F3 F1 F5
PRINT COHPILt OFCOHPILF I/O PROGRRH OPTION SET-UP MNEMONIC EDIT UllLllV ON-LLNt CUNCIION
Fig. 4.5.1
4.5.2
Editing
The source file of a sequence program is edited. (1) Start [Operation] il! Select (EDIT] from the main menu indicated below.
m
c
\ORIR\SRHPLI 1
Fl C2 C3 II 15 Fh tI t8 tY
EDIT PRINI CUnPLLt Df CnHPll~t l/O PROGRRH OPlION SCI-UP MNEMONIC EDIT UllLllV UN-LlNt tUNCIIllN
Off-line Menu
-28-
4. OPERATION
The followlng
editing
menu
screen
appears:
Editing
Menu
Select
data to be edited
function
key.
69
The
editing
screen
for the
selected
data
appears.
For example,
the
screen
below
is
displayed
when
[TITLE]
is selected.
EDIT
( TlTUi
m*<.
: y:,:. G&-@fj@~~~~$$;*$@&$$
1) 2) :O 4) 5) 6) 7) 8) 9) IO)
bWlllNI: TUJI. BLIUJIIH FMClllMi TWL NtW tK & NC id: IW IKu;W No EIIITIUN No IKo(;I(I\M Inbfwliw; No DATA It IRUXW4IftG IRffilbd DI:SICMiD WIM kRl1TEN BY Rim UY
NkW i l%NlJCF%CKIlELRC&I:16M4
:I
7 _I I
p%,r:
: 9, f
l,).q&
Editing
Title
-29-
4. OPERATION
(2) Termination
[Operation] cis Select
screen.
02
The following
E-1
F2 F3
function
(0
When editing
is selected. to a file.
(ii) When
is selected,
the editing
operation
is terminated
without
writing
the results
of editing
the display
returns
menu
screen.
function
The display
returns
452.1
(1) Start
- 30 -
4.
OPERATION
G9 The following
title edrting
screen
appears:
NAk
8) IRWAM W:SIGNRI) BY
!I) RtMMIIIKN HY
Fig. 4.5.2.1
(2)
Input
[Operation] (I) Select an input ttem (displayed in reverse video) with the -Z 1 > and < 7 > keys.
Q)
Enter data.
The maximum
number
of characters
usable
for each title data item IS listed below 32 characters 32 characters 32 characters
MACHINE MACHINE
NAME
: :
:
: : NO : : : : :
4 characters
2 characters
DRAWING
32 characters
16 characters 32 characters 32 characters 32 characters
-31-
4.
OPERATION
(3) Termination
[Operation ) 01 Select
B, [END] on press the -z ESC > key to return lo the editing menu screen.
The following
message
appears.
11
function
key.
The system
returns
to the editing
menu.
4.5.2.2
Ladder diagram/step
configuration screen
sequence
editing
lists subprograms,
and supports
the selection
and editing
of a target
subprogram
EDIT(LADDER/STEP
SEQUENCE)
0 D u 0
0 u .
PO006 PO026
q PO016
(7 PO101
cl PO202
m]PO304
[1]PO405
oJPO406
Sub-program
: PO001
ADRESS
DELETE
NEW
ZOOM
-32
4. OPERATION
a subprogram
number)
by [ZOOM]
LEVEL1
subprogram
or step seqence
Note 1) Note 2)
level can be omitted. key was used screen to nest a program upon to a certain press depth, and if the key,
configuration
a single
of the [MAIN]
the [ZOOM]
is suspended.
with n J.
: Displaying
previous
screen
next screen
of display
IEDIT(LADDER/STEP
Edit (LADDER/STEP PMC-RC4 (STEP
SEQUENCE) :
RC4(STEP
FAPT LADDER The list screen Setting Current a model directory
SEQ)
editing
[C:~FLADDERJ
screen
SEQUENCE) SEQ)
: : :
of subprogram
[ AxFLADDERv
PROGRAM:(STEP
PROGRAM
SEQUENCE
which
DEMO PROGRAM)
is one of the title data
Remarks
I ~LEVELI
LEVEL1 LEVEL2 LEVEL3
I lLEVEL2
i-tLEVEL3
: The 1st level of ladder : The 2nd level of ladder : The 3rd level of ladder
I1 1 PO001
I I
I- I] :
i1)POOO2
a subprogram
11 PO004
of the ladder
F-1PO005
: a subprogram
-33 -
4. OPERATION
New program
name ?D
of the subprogram
to be created
a subprogram
of the subprogram key. key. to be modified position (P200, the for example), to P200 then then press the press the or <Enter> Alternatively, cursor
or <Enter>
If a subprogram message
number
marked
with
LI]
(P21,
for example)
is selected,
the
following
is displayed:
Editing Continue
this to
subprogram select it ?
is
not
completed. [Yl
(Yes/No)
To continue session,
session
using
the results
obtained
from
suspended
previous
editing
press
To cancel
the results
of the previous
editing
session and
edit the subprogram from its original state, enter <N >.
-34-
4.
OPERATION
(2)
Editing
a ladder diagram
(4
Start Display the program list screen. press the [ZOOM] appears. or <Enter> Position the cursor lo the program indicated key. The ladder diagram editing screen, by 0, then
shown below,
CCO=lESI
DATR 00001
NO 1 RCO=RELRY
SANPLE
800Bl/kWOl 00001?
I
I
Fig. 4.5.2.2.2
(a)
command,
The line shows the name displayed on the screen, can be edited.
number
number (P address) or label number (L address). added to the data at the address selected by the
(iv) The lines show a symbol and comment cursor. 6, Q, AD = X000.0 SY = SAMPLE 0000 1 @ RCO = RELAY SAMPLE 00012 ($I CC0 =TEST DATA No. 1
: : : :
Address on which the cursor IS placed Symbol data Total number of symbols Relay comment Total character Coil comment Total data numbers of relay comment data numbers of symbol/coil comment
003000030
character
displayed on CRTIMDI.
-35-
4.
OPERATION
C-9Function
The ladder 0)
key indications
diagram editing
and selection
functions correspond to the function keys as indicated below.
(cornand] 63
[comand]
0,
holding
down [SHIFT]
items.
(a Under condition
1 2 :3
8.
,:?
holding
4
down [SHIFT]
5 ,&$&
the following
*
items.
g .I,., 11) $&i:
, j. .:i; : :y
[Delnet]
2 CihCet 3 search 4 <*down 5 <*&I#$ 6 7 MICI+ZI 8 9 '10 " I
I
I
t
WNC
inrnet
InstIn
his&n
7 .
.8
.' 9
10.
:.
!i? [Search]
2 bottom
rrch
W-W&
t+trth
g-srth
7 C-dOWi
i-Up
10
03 [Copy] I [Move]
1
until t
cancut
search
4 odown
'&up
7 *
10
to
*
cancel
Search
4 c+down
c*up
to-fil
ftS+orfi 8
10
(to-erg]
is displayed
in the [File]
command
mode
only.
(9
[File]
Opens a window in which the name menu. of an input program can be specified. Select desired processing from a POP-UP
do, [syEdit]
1 bX8C 2 cancel 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
-36-
4.
OPERATION
(Note)
keys
in ladder <A>
diagram and
editing, (COMAND]
can be executed.
entering
F4 [Adress]
command
the upper-case
letter
initial letter)
in the correspondrng
name shown
on the 8
6)
Ladder For
program
input input. select [LADDER] When from the editing menu. has been The entered, function key
ladder
program menu
programmer displays
IS displayed.
no sequence
program diagram.
the screen
rails of a ladder
At this stage,
program
to any location
of basic
(i)
Example
of basic
instruction
program
input
x0.1 X2.4
D30.2
F14.2
Y52.7
[Operation] Move the cursor The [ -I ILLEGAL to the start position. then press
[ -i
i-
1.
HORIZONTAL LINE the This message Enter warns
t_
] symbol
appears
The message
appears
of the screen.
line creatron
is not completed.
an address
<Enter
> key.
The address
is set at the
moves
As in 01 and 8.
enter
contact
A of D30.2.
B of F14.2.
[e
] and enter
address
F14.2,
then
press
the
<Enter>
key.
The
is set on contact
moves
right.
Without
moving
the cursor,
press extending
4
rail.
1.
automatically and a relay coil
A horizontal symbol
line segment
appears
-37-
4. OPERATION
Y52.7,
then press the < Enter > key. moves to the input start position on the next line.
automatically
an OR conditron.
[ -#+-
The address
Press To
[ -
] to enter a horizontal
a horizontal line, enter
enter
as many
entered.
Note, however,
A vertical vertical
line
extending
upward
is required
for OR.
Press
--!
) to enter
line extending
upward.
instruction
input. press
program input
the function key (functn]. Next, enter a SUB number,
then press the c Enter Z- key. A function number If the instruction can also be entered the [functn] remember lists function key. a certain instruction and name or SUB number, a function can be by entenng the function instruction name or SUB
instructions
corresponding
SUB
numbers
on the screen. can be displayed instruction just by pressing the (funcln] displayed. screen from the function instruction key without entering any data.
key to return
diagram
(1) (.j(!!~K,
(2) 0000
(3) 0000
(4)
Control
condition -Input -High-order When entering I parameters a function Low-order 4-bit 4-bit logical
address
multiplication data
data
multiplication
instruction instruction
of the function
as shown
-38-
4. OPERATION
[Operation
1
condition. 1. Next. right.. enter an address and bit data, then press the < Enter> key. [ ---I l--moves
The cursor
instruction. key. Next, enter shown SUB number above appears. 8. then press the <Enter> key. The
Instructton
diagram
instruction. multiplication automatically data of the first parameter. downwards. Enter then the
logical cursor
moves
remaining
three parameters
one by one.
related
to the ladder
1 net (corresponding
to the portlon
between
the RD
and WRT instructions) a) When the ladder 1 net exceeds program), 256 steps (as counted as steps in the
corresponding
mnemonic
the following
message
appears:
A limit of 256 steps per net was exceeded. If there are more than 256 steps, no net is displayed.
related
to a ladder
diagram more
display than
is made occurs.
to display
below
Symptom When there are more than 70 lines per net, the following The If 70 NET being created lines are is too large. the following message appears, and no net is message appears.
(a-1 1
exceeded,
(a-2)
When
there are more than 70 fines totaled appears. IS too large. when totaled
message The
If 70 lines message
over
two
or more
nets,
the following
net when
of the current
the number
of a net
IS
dlsplayed
- 39 -
4. OPERATION
The number of lines tn each net to be displayed is determined (b-l ) Basic instructions One line is comprised of one basic instruction.
+_I-
1 line
1-r
*lines
(b-2)
Function
The number of lines in a function instruction is: or parameters. Examples whichever is greater, plus 1
of calculation follow.
O_
Number of control conditions = 2 Number of parameters = 4 Number of lines = number of parameters + 1 = 5 lines
00
-4o-
4.
OPERATION
(b-3)
Data table section of function instructions The data table section of the COD, CODB, follows:
or DISP
instruction
is calculated
as
When the data table is one or two bytes Number of lines = number of data tables/6
( + 1 if there is a remainder)
0000
0000
0000
Number section
0000
of = = =
When the data table is four bytes Number of lines = number of data tables14 ( + 1 if there is a remainder)
0005
0007 D300 0320 000 002 004 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 Number section of = = = lines in the data table 514 1 with remainder 1 2 lines
-4l-
4.
OPERATION
(b-4)
Example
of calculating
the number
0011
0300
1
0000
0000 0000 0000
000
003 006 009 Net B
:
Net C
....... :
c)
Examples Example
of symptoms of symptom
(a-l)
can be edited only when (SUB the total number 396. of message data steps when 49) is less than This is because
diagram
consists
the following
appears,
-42-
4. OPERATION
Example
of symptom
(a-2) to enter the net of a function following message instruction on the same screen and the attempt as is
If an attempt that
is made
of a basic
instruction,
the
is displayed,
rejected. The NET being created if the basic is too large. instruction the net has 68 lines, total number of lines the MOVE exceeds instruction 70). (SUB 8) of
be entered,
(because below.
The results
calculation
are described
Dtsplay
screen
:-I
RST +I SUB 8 L+
68-line
net
:.
68 + 5 = 73 lines
< Measure
> of the 68-line net is not scrolled, the MOVE instruction can be entered.
If the display
net cannot
be entered
together
with another
basic-instruction
net, if
of lines is greater
than 70.
if a 68-line
basic-Instruction
net is followed
by another
basic-Instruction
net,
be entered.
rr Display screen
68-line
net
---I+
I
< Measure > of the 68-line net
IS
If the display
not scrolled,
can be entered
instructron
if an attempt DISP
Instructton
(SUB
and
-43-
4.
OPERATION
attempt The
This symptom
also occurs
In a combination
and a combination
of
CODB and COD instructions. For example, steps shown if the number of tables for the CODB instruction is 200, the total number The calculation results of are
instruction
can be only
66 at maximum.
. instruction
Display screen .._...... 196 198 00000000 00000000
._.. ._
00000000 00000000
I
. .
screen
Function instruction = 4 parameters section +1 Data table section = 20014 = 50 of DISP data items that can be entered instruction = 3 parameters + 1 of remaining = 70 - 55 - 4 = 11 lines 116=66 Calculation
_ instruction
Data tables =
total number
Restriction
number
of steps is as follows:
of ladder steps
EMS : 21840
: 24000 steps
that the maxrmum is used. edited exceeds message OVER the maximum is displayed: allowable number of steps, editing is allowable number of steps can decrease, depending
MNEMONIC
-44-
4. OPERATION
[Notes] 0) An attempt ladder IO scroll a program is incomplete program on the screen (for example, with a scroll key or other addresses) the screen or invalid. can be scrolled. keys fails if the
program ladder
without before
A correct
must be created
in one line on the screen. program format created exceeds in mnemonic this limit, it is
program
created
continuation to delete
symbol
-- ---
1.
Use
(Delnet]
(net
deletion)
this symbol.
(4
Replacing Lines
sections of a sequence
created sequence
program
program can be replaced rn the same way as described
in an already
in Item (c) above. Move the cursor to a program section to be changed, then enter new data.
@I Sequence
indicated
program
addition soft key of the function key programmer menu and use the function keys
To terminate
the programmer
menu,
iflrmt
oekl@Jt
Insert
Adren
Search
COPY
MOW
File
rygdtt
I Insert 1
As described
below,
of sequence
program
addition
in a ladder
diagram.
(i)
Example:
Addilion
HHt
To be added
Move
the cursor
to the position
to add item(s),
then
enter
item(s)
in
-45-
4.
OPERATION
When a vertical
line affects
addition
[Operation] Move the cursor Press to the position shown the above. line to the left extending upward. This
4_
] to delete
vertical
disappears. Press
J [ -
] to create
a vertical
upward
then press
1. A horizontal
a contact
[ -_I
] to add a contact.
vertically
(ii)
When
a line
is added
iii+. _
N- To be added
To add a line vertically, lower cursor key. Each time the [insnetj line down to create After line addition, large enough part of the ladder
To create
such an area,
the the
be shifted enclosed
diagram
in dashed
the [insnet]
key is pressed,
the lower
diagram
is shifted
one
Make an addition
[Operation]
Move the cursor Press [insnet]. The lower part of the ladder diagram is shifted down by one line. to any point in the ladder diagram enclosed in dashed Ilnes.
-46-
4.
OPERATION
without after
entering entering
a numeric a numeric
value, value,
specified
is inserted.
position
and press
-_1 f--j.
right.
data
moves
an OR circuit
(iii) Line
insertion
in a single-net
sequence
program
one by one.
(Operation] 0 Enter number the number of lines to be inserted, then press the (inslin] key. The entered
of lines is inserted. key is pressed without entering a number, just one line is added.)
-v-
-1
Cursor
If the (insltn]
key
IS
pressed
when
the cursor
is posttioned
as shown
In the left-hand
as shown
in the right-hand
figure.
sequence
program
[Operation]
of elements is Inserted.
to be inserted,
key.
The entered
c A> pressed.
is prefixed elements
of elements
to be Inserted
and the
without
1,
II
.. e .. ..,( .,.
II
-47-
4. OPERATION
(inselm]
when as shown
the
cursor
is placed
as shown
in the following
figure.
The element
when
the cursor
is
as shown
in the right-
hand figure.
The element
is inserted
(1) Deletion
in a sequence
program
deleted by positioning the cursor at the location to be deleted
(i)
can be partially
[ _____ I 4 I 2
] : ] :
relay coil, etc. to the left of the cursor. to the right of the cursor.
] :
(ii)
Use the
[Delnet]
key to delete
a program
net (section
from
an RD instruction
to a WRT
instruction).
(iii) Multiple
one by one.
in&net
Reklai
lfisert
&dress
Serrrh
&.&.
MWQ
..ki;e., SjrBiiR
[Delnet]
[Operation]
0 Deletion Move deleted the cursor to the net to be deleted, in red. then press the (Delnet] key. The net to be
is displayed
G? Deletino Move
multiple
nets by using keys such as the cursor the nets to be deleted the cursor in red. moves down key, [c-down] key, or [search] after a numeric
the cursor
is entered.
as many
-48-
4. OPERATION
: Press
r4, When the nets to be deleted are known beforehand, move the cursor to the first net to delete, enter the number of nets to delete, then press operatron. steps ci) and 8 (g) Searching in a sequence can be omitted. the [Delnet] key. With this
program
[Search]
U) Itop
When this key is pressed, the start of the sequence program is drsplayed on the screen and the cursor is moved to the start of the program. (ii) [bottom] When this key is pressed, the end of the sequence program is displayed on the screen and the cursor is moved to the end of the program. (iii) [srch] Search operatton using this key searches the program for aspecified address from the current location for the cursor on the screen to the end of the program. IS found, it is displayed on the screen. two ways. CiJ Address key. specrfication usrnq the cursor the [srch] the program for the specified address from the current is When an address
Move the cursor to the relay contact of the address to search for, then press Thus operatron searches location of the cursor on the screen to the end of the program. If the specified address displayed on the screen.
is found, the sectron of the program containg the address The cursor IS automatically positioned at the found address.
If the search operation fails to find the specified address, the cursor does not move. To terminate searching, press the < ESC > key.
-49-
4.
OPERATION
F54.1
Y52.3 I Cl
G11.6
I, II
.(
X4.2 Y49.1 032.0 b G43.1 - When the same address as this address is to be searched for, move the cursor to this position, then press the [srch] key.
x0.5
D21.2
- When the same address is found, the cursor moves to this location.
G3 Address soecification
Enter the address This operation of the cursor
by address
.
location
searches
to the end of the program. is found, The the section cursor of the program containing positioned the address at the found
screen.
is automatically
operation
address,
an error indication
appears.
(iv) [w-srch]
If multiple
is the
The address
soecification
usino the cursor coil with the address to search for, then press the [w-
to the relay
searches
the program
for relay coils with the specified to the end of the program. is found, the section
address
from the
address
of the
program
containing
it is displayed operation
on the screen
appears.
spectfication
input to search for with the keyboard, then press the [w-
searches
the program
for relay coils wrth the specified to the end of the program.
address
from the
of the cursor
on the screen
- 50 -
4. OPERATION
When
address
is found,
the section
of the program
containing it is displayed on the screen and the cursor is positioned at the relay coil. If the search operation fails to find a relay coil with the specified address, an error
Indication appears.
(v) [n-srch]
(net-number
search)
This key displays those ladders that have a specified net number, starting from the top of the screen. advanced If the [n-srch] key is pressed without entering a number, the display is
by one net.
If the [s-srch]
while the cursor is on a function instruction, function instructions with the same number as that function instruction are searched for.
(vii)Search
l l l
operation
keys (<
*,
Enter an address or symbol, then press a cursor key. Enter a NET No., then press a cursor key.
Enter a function instruction name, or enter S followed by a function instruction number, then press a cursor key. Example: Enter Sl, The function instruction is searched for. a cursor key. The function instruction END1 is
the source
programs is enabled.
The range of search All programs, whrch rnclude a currently dtsplayed subprogram, The subprogram a) b) c) d) is searched are searched for.
From the current cursor posttion to bottom of currently opening subprogram. From next numbered subprogram to last numbered one.
-51-
4. OPERATION
G-SRCH
mode continues
unless
pushing
key.
Whole program
-1 (Searching
numbered
subprogram
.
l
Searching
result of search in another is found, the cursor will move which to the position. is currently displayed will be
program,
the program
the program
which
contains
the
object,
will be opened
to display
the
object
with the cursor. time, whether to save or quit modifications is inquired, in case there are
modifications
in the program
to be closed.
When by one.
two or more
objects
exist,
the result
of search
are displayed
in order
of 1) one
- 52 -
4. OPERATION
Operation The global search is operated with the following functton key.
,,;~+.$-s+~
4-4
5 -t&&t*
6 -..-L-,~L~_a
,o&~er)
(cornand] 8
[comand]
2 D&net
insnet
Copy
&lrruc 8
Fk
iyhdlt
lo
d)
1
Select
2
the (G-srch]
3
with pushing
the [SHIFT]
(the following
will be displayed)
in state of 03
(Shortcut
command
is -z G >
+ [COMMAND])
Starting
mode of G-SRCH are searched by the operation unless quitting of 0) +O. mode.
It switches
G-SRCH
b)
Execution Refer
to (c)
program,
of global
c) End of G-SRCH
G-SRCH different mode individually. =
mode is ended by pushing <ESC > or [cancel] key. The end method is
- <ESC> - [cancel]
=
Only G-SRCH
mode
is ended.
The program
on the opening
now
is the state as it is. It returns SRCH Whether to the mode. program which was opened at beginning the G-
will save
is inquired,
modifications
in the program
is currently
displayed.
PI Copying sections of
A multiple-net sequence net can be copied remains as it was.
a sequence program
program can be copied net by net. edited Specify the net to be copied. file. The selected The net
tn the same
or into another
- 53 -
4.
OPERATION
File which
is being edited
file
Fig. 4.5.2.2
(b)
I
[Operation]
to
cancel
sear&
c-down
Pup
&fil
tu-arg
Copying Place
a net on the net to be copied and press the [Copy] key. The selected net is
the cursor
in yellow. two or more nets the nets to be copied, move the cursor up, cursor first move the cursor to the first net of the range end of the range key. to be by nets
then
the cursor
or [search]
in yellow. enter a numeric value and press the [c-up] or [c-down] key. The cursor
according
to the specified
value.
Setting
the copy
destination
key
(Copying
in the same
the cursor
to the copy
destination immediately
in the
same
file and
press
the
[to]
key.
The bv the
selected
above
the copy
destination
specified
- 54-
4.
OPERATION
cursor.
To copy
times,
enter
the number
of times
Specifying file) 1)
key
(Copying
key.
The following
message
is displayed.
If no program
is specified.
LATMP
is created. work file used in editing) and press the < Enter >
(LATMP 2) file:
,.
Temporary
3)
Select
desired
processing
POP-UP
menu:
4)
If the Select
selected desired
destination processing
the following
POP-UP
menu
is dispfayed.
---t -
Updates the selected file. The new copy replaces previous data of the file. Cancels output to the selected file. Appends the copy to the selected file.
the
are known
beforehand,
place
the cursor
on the key.
enter
of nets to be copied,
then press
the [Copy]
(0
program
can be moved net by net. to another Specify the net or nets to be place in the same file that is being
to another between
net or nets are deleted. IS that the selected net or nets are deleted rn
copying
and moving
fnznet
Oelfiet
Wart
Adrew
karch
COPV
Mawe
Pile
it&B
[Move] uirtll
c
cancel
search
c-down
C-U&l
- 55-
4.
OPERATION
(Note)
(i)
Combining
a sequence
program
A source program can be combined to another source program that is being edited. The source program to be combined can be displayed and edited separately, then combined to
Original screen
View screen
[SourcefiieSection to be edited
P-01
Combine File to be combined IVfEWJ Input combined (view file)
Fig. 4.5.2.2
(c)
Combining
a Sequence
Program
Programs of model which is different from the specified connection displayed.) In this case, no errors will be detected (TO] or enter [VIEW]. (If a disagreement
contains model.
range or function instruction format that does not agree with the specified will be detected in compilation.) When ignoring the warning message,
be extremely
-56-
4.
OPERATION
(i)
Function keys
[Comand]
itwhet
Delnet
Insert
A&en
Mitch
COPY
Mbw?
; Flli .
::... i@llt
d
SIIWPLE -+ t------__-_ YO 0 ---_c+I
I
I
~334~5ulumm3rn331~
rRD= 1SY=
cco-
wao1
RCO=
-___ _
- 57 -
4. OPERATION
(ii) Operation
flowchart
for combining
a sequence
program
1 Specify an Insertion point (The data is inserted Immediately above the cursor.)
r_lrC1T7
Specify a view file <POP-UP menu 1 (View) Shows the ladder < diagram of the file to be combined (View screen) 1. Check the displayed data of the file to be combined 2. Edit the data of the file to be combined and combine it Combines the(To) file with the Ladder program on the original screen 1. The file is immediately combined. The data of the file is not displayed. L _I 1 on the view screen
Press the -z ESC z= key to terminate -z POP-UP menu (Quit) Cancels the edited data -
editing
*I
(Temp)
(Edit) Returns to the ladder diagram screen (The view screen is continued.)
Fig. 4.5.2.2
Operation
-58-
4. OPERATION
(iii) Examples
Example
1. Combrning
a sequence
program
file
[Operation]
Place the cursor on the insertion point on the original screen.
Select
[File].
menu,
select
Fl (To).
/I
The
file
is inserted
immediately
above
the
net
specified
in step
QI>.
(Original
screen)
Example
2. Combining
a modified
sequence
program
(Operation] til Place the cursor on the insertion point on the original screen.
G3 Select
(File].
menu,
select
F2 (View).
jiil
Edit
the
program (Ladder
on the editing
view can
screen. be
To terminate and
editing, terminated
press in
the the
<ESC> conventional
performed
- 59 -
4.
OPERATION
menu,
select
Fl (Save).
Fl
F2 F3 F4 F5
Save (update) Quit Rename Edit Create Latemp file & Save
Return Then,
the name
in step $3.
The
file
is inserted
immediately
above
the
net
specified
in step
0.
(Original
screen)
Example
3.
Combining
a specified
section
of a sequence
program
[Operation] Place the cursor on the insertion point on the original screen.
Select
[File].
and press the < Enter > key.
menu,
select
F2 (View).
Select [until].
[Copy]
or [Move]
on the
view
screen
and
specify
a desired
range
with
the
following
function
menu,
select
(to-org].
(Specify
insertion
into
the
screen.)
cancel
search
c-down
c-up
to-fil
to-org
menu,
select
Fl (Exec)
The
data
is inserted
immediately
above
the
net
specified
in step
0.
(Original
screen)
-6O-
4. OPERATION
(k)
Editing
a symbol
from screen,
diagram
editing added
diagram
and comment
[syEdit]
[Operation] Specifying an address and comment in a ladder key. diagram, place the cursor on the corresponding
Editing
and comment to the symbol editing > key. section in the bottom moves right part of the screen. to the comment field. Edit
The cursor
editing
Terminates Terminates
key :
modifying
(1)
input
with
the [comand]
key with the [cornand] function key. key. Enter one of the character that are enclosed in
selected
[cornand]
Those
portions
can be omitted.
I
S M
D C F
(SY) E
The function
creation
and search
operations.
(Note)
The
keys
1c
or 4.)
and
[A
or-4
] are used
to create
or delete diagram.
a vertical
line
extending
upward
in a ladder
The menu
key depends
on the ladder
diagram
position.
-61
4.
OPERATION
(m) ZOOM Subprograms called by the currently and edited. selected programs issuing of a CALLCALLU instruction
(i)
Start up of zoom 0 Moved <Enter the cursor > key. to the parameter of the CALLCALLU instruction and push the
ROOl .O ACT IL
SUB65 CALL
PO01
The program
now
on opening
Then
the subprogram
which is specified by the parameter (ii) Start up under editing When ZOOM be inquired. is attempted Select either while editing
the program,
the preservation
of
modificatibns
will
(ii,) End When the end operation with the < ESC > key is attempted by ZOOM, it will return to the state when configuration screen ZOOM all at once. in the program editing Moreover, screen to
is started.
it is possible
~1 F2 F3 F4 F5
Fl :Save(update)
F2:Quit It returns to the program screen where ZOOM program screen IS cancelled. was started, after the content of current
-62
4. OPERATION
Lines at the cursor and after are shifted down, (* and ) is inserted. Then the cursor changes the area. The area for Net comment display mode) automatically expands into character-size
enclosed
by
cursor,
sentence
onto
and shrinks by two lines (four lines at four lines sentences. Every Net comment
R1000.2
) ) Y23.4 A
R1000.2
(ii) To determine
or cancel the editing Net comment the editing Net comment, and the Net comment press [ end ] or <ESC>. editing mode is finished. Then the editing
@I To determtne comment
is fixed,
To cancel cancelled
press
[cancel].
will be
Note)
is limited to 4095 bytes: counting one kana as one byte, one kanji character
as one byte,
(iir) To modify Net comment 0 Place the cursor on the Net comment < Shift z= + [netcmt 1 or < Enter > and the Net comment which you want to modify and press The Net comment ediling mode becomes active,
At Net comment
editing mode,
press [inslin].
- 64 -
4.
OPERATION
[inslin]
by one line,
and make
a blank
line
at the cursor
( Net comment ( ( All characters ( (3 At Net comment (* Net comment ( Net comment ( All characters ( [dellin] line. ( Net comment ( All characters will delete
) )
l )
*) [dellin].
editing
mode,
to delete
by line, press
l )
) ) )
whole
up by one
is written
in here.
l ) l )
To cancel the
press be
[cancel]. as
[cancel] it was
modifications
restored
modifications.
(iv)To
delete
normal
ladder
nets. -x [exec]
area to delete
Entering cursor
Net comment
editing
mode
by <Shift
> + [netcmt]
or
<Enter
> with
the
[delete].
(v) Lost Net comment A Net comment Net comment consists pointer, These two of the information and Net of posttion string in sequence data which one program which is called
is comment to one to
elements might
combined
be lost by illegal
file operations
or something,
file .#LA
or modifying pointer
as blank on
Net comment
by ( Net
and ) comment
which can
is be Net
monochrome Lost
display.
by editing
Net comment
be edited
as a normal
such as deletion,
copying
and so on.
-65-
4. OPERATION
This specification
of
program.
0)
To enter New page 0 Move the cursor to the position you want to feed page. And then press <Shift > +
1 page 1.
R1000.2
Y2000.4 A
R1000.2
Y23.4
n v
R1000.2
Y2000.4
page> Y23.4
----1Hl
(ii) Other operation to edit New page
New page can be handled as same as other ordinary ladder nets. copying [ Copy 1, moving ( Move 1, and deleting [Delnet] New page.
The operations
such as
(q)
Terminating
editing
of a sequence
program
[Operation] 0 Press the < ESC > key on the following editing screen.
- 66 -
4.
OPERATION
The following
editing
end menu(pop-up
menu)
appears.
a)
& quit of the editing is preserved, the editing screen will be ended.
content
b)
F2:Quit Alter current content of the editing is cancelled. the editing screen will be ended.
c)
& quit of the editing is preserved into specified subprogram name, the
content
will be ended.
d)
F4:Edit The < ESC > key operation is canceled and it returns to the editing screen of former.
e)
F5:Main With the operation was started a).b) or c). it returns it returns to the program to a program screen where screen ZOOM at all
configuration
is selected screen
configuration
screen,
When error net exists When the error net exists, ERROR NET NO. is displayed and the end menu is not
displayed.
a)
or deleted
the end
b)
When
pressed
< ESC> of 8
key
in the
state
of 0
after
CAN
is typed
(meaning
of
CANCEL),
the menu
will be displayed. it will be preserved it will be able after removing to return to the the error net. state before editing by
cancelling
of the editing.
-67-
4. OPERATION
(3)
diagram to a program editing screen marked with 01, then press below: the [ZOOM] or < Enter > key.
the cursor
is displayed
as shown
ZDIT(LADDER/STEP
SEQUENCE)
Cl s3 P3 s4
Sll
cl s13
Cl s21
s31
n s15 r======================I=I
S24 l-l
Note
_. 1)
1 (Note 1)
The current The entire position screen of the cursor consists on the screen across is indicated. the screen to of 32 elements
The cursor
is positioned
on the screen.
screen,
different
soft keys
are displayed,
depending
on the position
of the
softkey
menu
is displayed.
I
n1 s2
I
III SlQ
I
Cl s20
+ L4 L-1 s30
LBL -L FUNC
CHK ZOOM
r1
1111
1 II
JMP
[ (
Cl
[Ll]
( +-LBL
: : : :
Label for jump The end of block step Various functions checking
I
[
-ICHK
I:
] ] ]
rl]
[ FUNC [ ZOOM
I I [ -+JMP
Grammatical Zooming
: Jump to label
into a subprogram
-68-
4.
OPERATION
When the cursor is on the transition line, following softkey menu is displayed.
P30
t
1==
1 f-.-
(f-1
FUNC
CHK
ZOOM
I t
I l1
l=
I I I t1
T=
I
[ FUNC [ CHK
[ ZOOM
1 I 1 I 1 1 1 I 1 I
: : : : : : : : : :
Transition Divergence Divergence Line for link Convergence Convergence of selective sequence of simultaneous sequence of selective sequence of simultaneous sequence
(i)
Entering a step Position the cursor to the desired input position, then press the [Cl] key. Then, enter a step number and subprogram number.
as shown below
q Sl
I t
STEP ACTION
: Sl : l-l
101
I:1 1
JMP
+- LBL
-L
FUNC
CHK
ZOOM
in thus example)
-69-
4. OPERATION
STEP ACTION
: 61 : PlO l-l
To change
press the
<Enter
the character
cursor
on
the number.
STEP ACTION
(ii)
Entering Position
a transition the cursor to the desired number input position, then press the [ + ] key
Enter a subprogram
I
InI Sl
PLO0
+ ACTION : l-2
I+_Il==l
number.
It-_l
FUNC
CHK
ZOOM
Enter a subprogram
I
[l3lsl
PlOO
+
ACTION : PlOO l-2
-7o-
4. OPERATION
(vii)
Specifying Position
a label for jump destination the cursor to the desired input position (step line), then press the [c LBL] key.
IiWI Sk
III
PI0
PlOO
LABEL
: Llo l-l
[l.ll
I II
JMP
LBL
-L
FUNC
CHK
ZOOM
STEP ACTION
: $1 : PlO l-1
-73-
4.
OPERATION
(viii)
Specifying Position
a label jump the cursor to the dewed input position (step line), then press the [JMPJ key.
Press the [-
JMP]
key.
t I
LlO
[OISl
to
Ells2 f PlOO .LEBEL : 2-3
[Ul
01
--*JMP
+-LBL
-L
FUNC
CHK
ZOOM
+ LlO [UlSl
PlOO
--, tY.cl
LEBEL
: Llo 2-3
-74-
4.
OPERATION
Deleting Position
an element the cursor to the element to be deleted. then press the < Delete > key.
shown
above.
two figures
(elements)
of a selective cursor,
branch
are
Specify To position
to be deleted displayed
displayed
in reverse
--
PlOO
above,
the selective
branch
is deleted
and
IO] Sl
PlOtt
-75-
4.
OPERATION
To specify
another
figure,
I
IO1 Sl
PlQO
i
an element the cursor to the desired insertion > key. and <Insert > keys position, then press the c Insert > key. To create
I
IO1 Sl
c ,;,= = = i= = = = ;
dlS2
P2
IP1l
I1
SlO
Cl s20
PlO
t
P20
n
I
s3
n I
Sll
STEP ACTION
-76-
4. OPERATION
c
PI
1-3
I
101 Sl
c
Pl
============
I
rllS2
n SlO
P2 PlO t r3
I i-l
s20
P20 t
t Ll I
s3
Sll
Ll s21
I
STEP ACTION
I
: s2 : P102
l-3
- 77 -
4. OPERATION
(xi)
Search
Pl ~,=y==
ols2
i ====
El
; = cl s20
SlO
Pl ;. ciilS2 1 u I
Pll t 0 I
P21
SlO
s20
key is pressed
above,
a pop-up
menu
is displayed
as
l-7
Fl F2 F3 F4 F5 Search COPY Move mAin List
I I
Ells3
El Sll
s21
(Search)
key.
A pop-up
menu
is displayed,
as shown
below:
Pl ===========
uls3
F6
Toe
jP7180ttoln
-78-
4. OPERATION
(Step)
key.
Another
pop-up
menu is displayed,
as shown
below:
Pl
.xb
La
SI
search
string:%Ai
Position
Toe Bottom
to be searched through
key.
starts searching
to the cursor.
Fl F2 ;: F5
Se Co F1 ",; ;: Li %:
(xii)
Copying
or moving
an element key.
Pl I t
Pll t
P21
-79-
4.
OPERATION
key is pressed,
a pop-up
menu
is displayed
as shown
below:
Fl F2
F3
F4 F5 :
mAin List
key.
The system
prompts
the operator
Pl =========PI
I
L71s2 cl
SlO
I
Ll s20
Pl
i......+
Pll
1
P21
Specify
l-2
Posltion
the cursor
shown
below),
then
The system
the operator
l-t
i
Pl ===========
I
cl s10
I
17 s20
13JS2
Pl +
P21
Specify
2-3
-8O-
4.
OPERATION
Position
the cursor
to the desired
shown
below),
then
The system
the operator
a copy destination.
Pl ===PIIP===I
SpeciEy
: 3-4
Position
the cursor
to the desired
copy destination
(position
shown
below),
The specified
part is copied.
t
==I=====
ACTION
: PlOO 4-3
If required,
-81
4.
OPERATION
(xiir) Returning
destination configuration
configuration
screen
displayed
when editing
was started,
The system
assumes
subprogram,
program
file.
key.
(t
Pl t==========
I
UlS2
Pl i t 17 SlO
I
u s20
Pll t
P21
After pressing
key
I+
Pl ===========
After pressing
EDIT(LADDER/STEP
SEQUENCE)
u 0 0
0 0
c-1 PO202
01PO304
tT]]PO405
-82-
4. OPERATION
Following
Function
key
Other keys
[ MAIN [ CHANGE
(ZOOM
] :Displaying
configuration
: Displaying
previous
screen
next screen
] :Creating J :Modifying
Screen
display
U]P200
which
is being
edited
key is pressed
to nest the in is
depth,
nested.
displayed
I0
following
PO008
(ii
PO009
c~] PO014
PO015
fl
PO016
PO017
Subprograms mark:
referenced
by the subprogram
that
is currently
being
edited
are listed
with the
:
subprogram subprogram
0
cl]
: :
Ladder
Step sequence
(xv) Checking
It
Pl
cl162
Pl
I
II
SlO
Ll
I
s20
Pll t t
P21
-84-
4. OPERATION
key is pressed, the figure pointed by cursor decides the type of subprogram
which is to be edited.
Figure cl
Subprogram
to be edited
01
n1 t
Ladder subprogram
Fl F2 F3 F4 F5 I
b quit
Menus
Editing Updated
Result of editing
Discarded Continued
Continue
Rename
optimize
End I Continue
Optimized I Optimized
-86-
4. OPERATION
4.5.2.3
l
Moving
< t
<Shift>
>, < +
>, CT
>. <
1 >
Moves Moves
to another to another
+ <t>,<-+>
be edited.
Entering When
a comment a front-end
in Japanese processor for Japanese containing word input is used, a comment can be entered characters characters in is
Japanese. compiled
kana characters
or m-type
alphanumeric alphanumeric
file is created),
and m-type
are replaced
with spaces.
(1) Start
[Operation] 0 Select [SYMBOL] (symbol and comment) from the editing menu.
The following
symbol
and comment
editing
screen
appears:
RDDRESS SYMBOL
Xlwm3.8
SYMBOL-A'
Fig. 4.5.2.3
- 87 -
4.
OPERATION
(2)
Entering
a new symbol
and comment
An input window
opens
on the screen.
t
Address field
t
Symbol field Relay
t
COmmenl
t
Coil comment field
Enter an address
in the address
entry field.
$9 The cursor
is positioned
to the symbol
entry field
Enter symbol
data.
is positioned
entry field.
data.
@I The cursor
is positioned
entry
field.
(9
data.
@I The entered
data is stored,
clearing
the previous
address,
symbol
data
When data.
no symbols
and comments
are entered,
the system
is automatically
set to receive
new
(3) Editing
a symbol
and comment
A symbol
and comment
assigned
to an address
can be edited
[Operation] (1) If the system is set to receive new data, select (QUIT] to exit from that state.
Move
the cursor
by pressing
< + >, < ? >, or < 1 ) key and edit the data
the < Shift > key press the -z t) or < + >
To move key.
the cursor
withln
a field, while
pressing
- 88 -
4. OPERATION
Select
[DELETE].
The following
message
appears
on the screen.
Comment
data copied
to paste buffer
is to be moved.
Select
[PASTE]
8
0
Select
[COPY].
The following
message
appears
on the screen.
Comment
data copied
to paste buffer
is to be copied.
Select
(PASTE].
The following
input window
appears
on Ihe screen.
SEARCH
or address
to be searched
-89-
4.
OPERATION
searches
or address
number
in that order.
The
is moved
to the searched
(7) Deleting
Select
[DELETE].
are deleted
[Operation
Select
[DELETE].
symbol
or comment
is deleted.
simultaneously
Select message
IAREA]. appears
The
entrre
line
is displayed
in reverse
video,
and
the
following
on the screen.
Selectrng
the area
Select
[DELETE].
in reverse
video
is deleted.
(8) Terminating
[Operation] 0) On the edit screen, select [END] or press the < ESC> key
The following
message
appears
on the screen:
Fl
F2 F3
8 quit
Specify
a desired
option
-9o-
4. OPERATION
(9) Editing
screen
/ Total
EDIT
+YYMBOL
COMMENT
PMC-RB4
<O>[A:vFLYDATAYRB4
NO.
(Motel)
00001 X00000.0 AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA 00002 X00000.1 BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB 00003*X00000.2 CCCCC 1 I*' means a symbol data which can be displayed
,;
..j
2 s;e#tfl
3 .::.#@A : 4
ADD
5 :;;:,:i$ .,...I 6 &TE.. , ,; ,;.,.:I ., :: .a &$&i I,.:: 9 ;..&&&" ,c, &$' '.. .., :. .. .
are displayed with turning at this point in ladder
Note
1)
Symbol/comment
screen.
(10) Searching
Search
by a part
function
is active
COMMENT. Especially strings. 1) Press [SEARCH] and the pop-up menu apears changes to specify strings for search. you can find relay/coil comment, which is too long, by specifing a part of data
Furthermore,
the display
of function-key
as the undermentioned.
I1
2)
NO.
AORS
3 SYMbQL 4 RELAY
.&tl,.
,. : .: .: 8
,I
1. ,:I. 9 1...... .: .
,o
:. ,,
Input strings
and specify
by function-key.
A part of strings
is available
3)
If search
is success,
cursol
moves
-9l-
4. OPERATION
4.5.2.4
Message editing
can be displayed on the CRT/MD1 screen of the CNC, using the DISPB is created as
Such a message
(1) Types
and quantity
of characters
that can be used data vary lrom one CNCPMC model to another, as
usable in message
Characters CNCPMC JIS levels 1 and 2 PMC-Rf33RB4/RB5/RB6/ RC3IRC4 F18 F15B Power Mate (A : Some characters PMC-RA3 PMCNBINB2 n X Full-size
hiragana
F16
0 0
X
0 0 0 0
LAUUtH.)
0 0 0 0
_----.
characters
can be entered
Japanese-language
1) When only full-size Japanese-language characters are used 2) When only half-size kana characters are used
3) When only alphanumeric characters are used
: : :
(2) Edit procedure The edit method language describes that can be used varies between half-size characters) can be the CNCiPMC used and model in which Japanese models. characters This section (excluding other
the procedure
common
to all models
(only alphanumeric
are entered),
as an example.
-92-
4.
OPERATION
The following
message
appears.
EDIT
W&AGE) NSSAGE
_~
IO ADDRESS
002 AOO. I
003 A00.2
004 A00.3
Fig. 452.4
(a)
Message
(b) Input
[Operation] 0 Place the cursor on the message address where message data is to be entered
message
data
(c)
Modification
[Operation] (11 Place the cursor on the message address where message data is to be entered.
The character
cursor
moves
on to the message
at the location
where
modification
is required,
keys.
characters
to modify
the message
data.
> key.
(d) Search
[TOP]
[BOTTOM]
The cursor
moves
address.
-93-
4. OPERATION
(e) END
[Operation) 0 On the edit screen, press [END] or < ESC >.
The following
message
appears.
Select
items,
452.5
The address
(1) Startup
[Operation]
0 Select [MODULE] (l/O module) from the edit menu.
The following
I/O module
edit screen
appears.
ADDRESS x0000
x0001
GROUP
BASE SLOT
ADDRESS YOODO
YDOOI
CROUP
BASE SLOT
NME
x0002 x0003 x0004 x0005 X0006 XODDI x0008 x0009 XOOIO x0011 x0012 x0013 x0014 x0015
YODOZ YDDO3 YDW YOOOS vooD6 vooo7 YOOOB YOOO9 YOOIO YODll YDD12 YDD13 YOOl4 YOO15
Fig. 4.5.2.5
(a)
I0 Module
Edit Screen
-94-
4. OPERATION
EDIT II/O ICHANNEL 11 1 ADDRESS xoool x0002 x0003 x0004 x0005 X0006 x0007 XGQOE xOiw9 x0010 XOOII x0012 x0013 x0014 x0015 GROUP i 0 0 0
\B& ADDRESS YOoilO YOoill YOoO2 YGilO3 YooO4 Yooo5 YOOo6 YOoO7 YOOo6 YOO09 YOOIO YOOll YOO12 Yoo13 YOol4 YOOIS GROUP BASE SLOT NAUE I
xoooo
ux ux
x(1 XI
I/O Module Edit Screen (models in which more than one cl annel can be set) (only for models in which more than one channel can be set) .
(2) Channel
(I)
switching
[Operation] 0
(ii) Select
[NXT.CH].
to the previous channel:
To switch
[Operation)
0 (3) Setting (Operation] 0 Place the cursor on the start address when a module is to be set.
Select [PRV.CH].
address
in the following
format:
GROUP.BASE.SLOT.NAME
(Note 1)
name
on the model
of the PMC in
Selecting
can display
(Note 2)
is allocated a group
: : :
Specify
number
Must be fixed at 0. Specify power the unit number ON/OFF information of the I,0 Unit-B. Alternatively, set to 0 if
## is to be allocated.
4.
OPERATION
[Input item] COUNTER DATA TYPE specifies whether the format of a counter value used with the CTR
This parameter
lnitral value
0 : BINARY
Setting
0 : BINARY / 1 : BCD
LADDER
EXEC (ladder execution time) specifies an incremental setting reduces ladder processing scan time, time for the first and second ladder thus achieving high-speed ladder
Initial value
100
Setting range
1 to 150
penod of 8
time
Note
l l l
however,
that increased
ladder execution
levels
reduces the following processing times: PMC screen display time Language program processing time
LANGUAGE As the
EXEC RATIO program and PMC screen display have the same priority, this
language
parameter
l l l
PMC screen display time Language program processing time Processing time of third-level Ladder program cyclically.
Initial value
50
Setting range
0 to 99
-99-
4. OPERATION
LANGUAGE This
ORIGIN specifies the start address of the link control statement data of a
parameter program.
language
Initial value
000000
Setting
range
Address area
in the language
program
storage
I
is no language program,
I
OOOOOOH.
When there
specify
OPERATOR
PANEL
operators operators
specifies
specify
the
addresses transferred
operators operators
connected,
an address
and an addresses
to the operators
itial value
0 : NO
Setting
0 : NO 1 1 : YES
KEY DI ADDRESS Specify the start address connected. (PMC address) of the external DI where the operators
panel is actually
Settrng
range
X0 to X127,
Xl000
to X1019
ii)
KEY DO ADDRESS Specify the start address connected. (PMC address) of the external DO where the operators
panel is actually
Setting
range
YO to Y127,
YlOOO
to Y1014
iii)
KEY BIT IMAGE ADDRESS Specify programs. Usually an arbitrary internal relay area is set. the start address (PMC address) of key images referenced by user
iv)
LED BIT IMAGE ADDRESS Specify programs. Usually an arbitrary internal relay area is set. the start address (PMC address) of LED images referenced by user
- loo-
4. OPERATION
4.5.3 4.5.3.1
Printout Overview
program can be printed out.
A sequence
EPSON
setting)
(Note)
and FANUC
PRINTER,
a program
modilication
is required.
For
4.5.3.6.
(2) General
t [SETUP]
Fig. 4.5.3.1
Operation
Flow of Printout
- 101-
4. OPERATION
453.2
Printing
SYSIEM PRRAWETER SYMBOL 8 COMWFNI LROOER OIRGRRH STEP SEOUENCE OIRGRRH I/O HOOULt HESSRGE CROSS REFERENCF LIST BII ROORESS MRP [OPTION1 INOm1 IOPTIONI '"PTIONI 8% 'ml1 rurlION1
Fig. 4.5.3.2
Drawing
Output
Menu
(Operation] ci, Set the desired print format by pressing F2 [SETUP]. (See Section 4.5.3.4.)
b,
output
items.
(See Section
4.5.3.3.)
CZ Start printing
by pressrng
Fl (PRINT].
Press F9 [BREAK]
to suspend
printing.
C!
display.
Note 1) Note 2)
Perform
must be changed.
Some
that cannot
be set in step 0) may be set by editing For details, see Section 4.535.
the setting
file before
FAPT LADDER-II.
-102-
4. OPERATION
453.3
(1) Specifying
output
of each
data item
Specify whether
a data item is to be output, by pressing the < 7 > key or < 1 > key after
positioning the cursor with the < c > key or c + > key on the drawing output menu screen.
(2) Option
specification position the cursor to the desired screen will appear. To set the
When specifying a data item for which options are available, option, then press the < Enter :, key.
option, enter the desired value, then press the < Enter > key.
(3) Detail a)
b)
Parameter
printing is printed.
The data of the system parameters c) Symbol printing The symbol comment
data is printed.
:\DRTF!\SflWPLE
SYMBOL
FlB
( ESC 1
END
Fig. 453.3
(a)
- 103 -
4.
OPERATION
i)
. .
When
printing symbol/comment
data,
specify
an output
range.
When
0 is
specified as the print end line number, all data up to the last line is printed. Comment [RELAY] [COIL] [ALL] specification
: Prints relay comment data. : Prints coil comment data. : Prints both relay comment data and coil comment data.
d)
r--
END
_J
Fig. 4.533
(b)
i)
Optton (ladder diagram printing) The output unit, net range, page break, and cross-reference of a ladder
diagram
to be printed is output
If a diagram module.
If 0 is set as the output continues If a page every up to the last net. break is specified,
a range
of nets is specified,
printing
a page
break
is made
in the ladder
diagram
at
new file or subprogram. is specified, (Fig. 4.5.3.3 (h)) the ladder diagram is accompanied with a
- 104-
4.
OPERATION
e)
Printing of step sequence figure Step sequence figure is printed i) Option (Step sequence figure printing)
:\DtllA\SRWPLE
I 1 oRLLn5m5l r~/vEsl
FlB
t tsc
END
PRINT UNIT Specify whether a step sequence figure will be printed for a single subprogram or all subprograms. When printing a figure for a single subprogram, specify the subprogram name for MODULE NAME.
SUB-PROGRAM
NUMBER
Specify whether subprogram number Pxxx will be printed for each step. f) I10 module printing The I/O module data is printed.
9) Message printing
The message data is printed.
\DRTR\SRMPLE
- --I
MESSRGE
rn
18 I FSC I
END
- 105 -
4. OPERATION
i)
Option
(message
h)
Cross-reference A cross-reference
Fig. 4.5.3.3
(e)
Cross Reference
Menu
i)
Option CHECK Check DUPLICATE multiple WRITE to a coil and counter). multiple use of same number functional
writing
address.
It can be specified
as below.
Table 453.3 Address ALL Initial letter of an address Bit address Byte address specification mode
List Address
I I All addresses
Y
Rl .O x10
IAll addresses
I Specified Specified (including
having
a specified only
initial letter
Address
range
in a specified
range address
after a specified
(Note
1)
When
an address
specification
is made,
addresses P.
are output
X, Y,
all
address,
In this
example,
Y and
-106-
4. OPERATION
APPOINT Specify
RELAY COIL
ii)
Bit address
.\DAlA\SRMPLE
FIB
I FSC
FND
Fig. 4.5.3.3
(f)
Bit Address
Menu
iii)
Option
map)
Output ALL
USED
of outputting
addresses.
For details,
refer
Fig. 4.5.3.3
(f) in
Reference.
-107-
4.
OPERATION
(1)
Printout
example
by F2[SETUP]
(print menu)
<graphical
Pl PlOO + c-L1 0 s210 fP160 Divergence of selective sequence cDivergence of simultaneous I sequence 0 S217 -Convergence of simultaneous sequence Step 4 ( Label Transition
Transition Label
e + P160
Divergence
S211
S215
s211
: P151 + P152
; S215 : P161
+ P162
of selective sequence t-Divergence of simultaneous sequence S217 : P165 f-Convergence of simultaneous sequence
4
Step
Convergence
Convergence
El*
SlOOO
: P2000
+ P102
Jump
->Ll
Jump
(2) Printout
example
by SUB-PROGRAM
NUMBER
[NO/YES]
AlSl
PlOO c-L1 0 5210 i-f P160 /j+i
1
Fig. 4.5.3.3 (i)
Pl
P160
Diagram (l/2)
- 109-
4. OPERATION
(3) Printout
example
El
Cl
0 t
I
tt d
Cl Cl cl
tttll
q r-l-l
cl cl cl cl
22 element (28 element)
tttt
cl
cl
cl
cl
14 element
Note)
The maximun element count for printing without sub-program number is given in parentheses.
(l/3)
q
7G-l cl cl t cl ttt vl v2 t Cl VI 0 tt cl J 0 t v2 Cl
cl p=>: 0
<- L>
r5=>-, L
Link number
(33)
Cl
cl
t
v3
Cl
4= > J (23)
v3 0
= >4 cl
Fig. 4.5.3.3
(I)
Diagram (2/2)
-llO-
4. OPERATION
4.5.3.4
Specify
Print format-l:
printer forms
SETUP
menu
as described below.
PtlPER SIZE
/ LADDER PRINT
Fig. 4.5.3.4
SETUP
Menu Screen
[Operation
]
F2 [SETUP] menu from the output screen appears. item (e.g., forms size/ladder diagram print format) with the item selection screen.
Select
the cursor
to a desired
< t > or < 1 > key. @I Select 6) Position the item by pressing the cursor
7
the < Enter > key. desired item (e.g., 10 INCHIASCII) by pressing the screen with the < 7 >,
to the
< 1 >,
item
< c >, or -z -+
@ If FlO [END] selection
is selected
screen.
size/ladder a forms
diagram size.
print format specify (GRAPHIC). is indicated by *. whether to print the ladder diagram in character
In addition, format
The currently
output
format
-lll-
4. OPERATION
4.5.3.5
file)
using frames a commercially can be changed. -PR201-10 . INF PR201-15 . INF PR201-A4 INF PRlO-A INF PRl5A INF PRA4-A : INF ESC-P-10 INF ESC-P-15 . INF ESCPl O-A. INF ESCPIS-A. INF -FANUC-10. INF available text editor -5
in each of the following DAT the paper name top margin net interval printer model
-AMROFTRP. [Diagram output ]b + 1. 2. 3. 4. Change selection Set the Set the Set the paper
and
-CROSSINF.
DAT
--f
(Setting the cross-reference list output format) 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. Set the guidance Set the Specify Set the guidance Specify Specify output format information output information the output format read/write coil information the linefeed the page break 5. 6. Set the line spacing Set the left margin
-(Message --)
7.
file)
here.
-112-
4. OPERATION
name
This item makes it possible to change the name of each choice during diagram output format
Point of change
Settings
#l O-A = 1O-inch/ASCII #l O-G = 1O-inch/graphic #15-A = 15inch/ASCII #15-G = 15_inch/graphic #A4L-A = A4 portrait/ASCII #A4L-G = A4 portrait/graphic
#A4L-A= and #A4L-G =are unavailable in the output to VPlOOO. the top margin
This item makes it possible to specify the top margin of a diagram when it is output.
Point of change
Settings
Decimal number
(3) Setting
By modifying this item, the spacing between the LADDER nets used during diagram printout can be changed in the manner shown below.
II
II
YO.0 *00006
NO0004
l 00006
NO0005 E
HHbl)L,,
YO.1
YO.0
+00006 YO.2 +00008 NO0005
YO.7
00001
YO.1
YO.7 00001
-lHHIL-ilF
YO.0 +00006 YO.1
YO.7 00001
YO.2 *00008
When LCNTL = 4
When LCNTL = 5
-113-
4.
OPERATION
Settings 4 or 5 ,
This item
selection.
can
change
the
printer
model
and
paper
that
are
specified
during
paper
*.INF that can be set PRlO_A INF PR201_10 . INF ESCPlO A.INF ESC_P_iO. INF FANUC_10. INF PRlO_A .INF PR201_10 .INF ESCPlO A. INF ESC_P_iO. INF FANUC_10. INF PRlS_A .INF PR201_15 .INF ESCP15 A.INF ESC_Pj5. INF PRlS_A .INF PR201_15 .INF ESCP15_A.INF ESC_P-15. INF PRA4_A PR201_A4 .INF INF
Printer
name
Print paper type/print 1O-inch 1O-inch 1 O-inch 1 O-inch continuous continuous continuous continuous
mode
:
C.-FILE =
PR201 PR201 VP1000 VP1000 FANUC printer PR201 PR201 VP1000 VP1 000 FANUC printer PR201 PR201 VP1000 VP1 000 PR201 PR201 VP1000 VP1 000 PR201 PR201
form/ASCII form/graphic form/ASCII form/graphic form/ASCII form/ASCII form/graphic form/ASCII form/graphic form/ASCII form/ASCII form/graphic form/ASCII form/graphic form/ASCII form/graphic form/ASCII form/graphic
1O-inch continuous 1O-inch 1 O-inch 1 O-inch 1 O-inch 1 O-inch 15inch 15-inch 15-inch 15inch continuous continuous continuous continuous continuous continuous continuous continuous continuous
#10-G
C.-FILE =
#15-A
C;FILE #15-G
C-FILE
15inch continuous 15-inch continuous 15-inch continuous 15-inch continuous A4 portrait, A4 portrait,
PRA4_A PR201_A4
INF .INF
PR201 PR201
A4 portrait, A4 portrait,
(Note)
= are unavailable
in the output
to VPIOOO.
- 114-
4. OPERATION
(5) Setting
This item can specify the line spacing of a diagram when it is output. the one specified according to the descriptions in Section 1.4.4.
Point of change
Settings
(H) (18) (C) (T < decimal number > ) ; (H) (1B) (C) (Tcdecimal number >) ;
(6) Setting
This item can specify the left margin of a diagram when it is output. one specified according to the descriptions in (4).
Point of change
Settings
number>)
-115-
4. OPERATION
Vame of file to be
edited .PRTOUT. .PRTOUT. JPN. ENG.
Point of change
Settings
(C) ( <any
character
@ CMT.TITLE
(-
SYMBOL
& COMMENT
-)
@ LAD-TITLE
(LADDER DIAGRAM -)
@ STEP-TITLE
(STEP SEQUENCE DIAGRAM -)
@ IO-TITLE
(I0 MODULE DATA -)
@ MSG.TITLE
(MESSAGE DATA -)
@ TIT.TITLE
(TITLE DATA -)
@ CRSTITLE (CROSS-REFERENCE -)
@ BKTITLE
(BIT ADDRESS MAP -)
(Note
1)
These
point of changes
ENG.
(Note 2)
Half-size
katakana
characters
cannot
be used.
lnformatlon
informatron to be output during with no semicolon at the beginning
characters
as guidance
file, lines
Point of change
Settings
string consisting
of up
-116-
4.
OPERATION
This item can specify step and/or net numbers to be output as cross-reference
file, lines with no semicolon
Point of change
Settings
When the net and step numbers are output in the stated sequence: NET-INT STEP-INF = 1 =2
When the step and net numbers are output in the stated sequence: NET-INT STEP-INF =2 = 1
Point of change
Settings
Character
string + %s
(Note)
-117-
4. OPERATION
(11)
Setting
the cross-reference
list read/write
coil guidance
In the CROSSINF.DAT
Point of change
Settings
Character 13 bytes.
string consisting of up to
READ = -1 IWRITE = -( )-
-1 ! I-
-( / )- :
(12)
Specifying
the cross-reference
This item can insert a space line between semicolon at the beginning are valid.
Point of change
Settings
Decimal number
(Note)
between between
count, no space
(13)
Specifying
the cross-reference
list page
This item can specify a page break between with no semicolon al the beginning are valid.
Point of change
Settings
-118-
4.
OPERATION
Environment
#PAPER = 10-G = 10 inch/ASCII LENGTHL = 11 LENGTH = 11 WIDTHL = 10 WIDTH = 10 PITCHL = 15/l 20 PITCH = 20/l 20 LINESL = 83 LINES = 55 RATIOL = 213 RATIO = 213 GRAMODL = 14 GRAMOD = 16 ANKMODL = 0 ANKMOD = 1 LEFTMGL = 0 LEFTWG = 0 L TOPMGL = 0 . TOPMG = 0 . LCNTL = 4 L C-FILE =PRlO_A.INF 4Fl;E = PRTDAT.DMP
Changing the types of printout paper The name is changed from 1:lO inch to l:NEC 10. see Fig. 52(e) in Part I.) *
I #IO-A
Changing the upper margin (The upper margin is set to * 5 characters.) Changing the types of printout paper (The name is changed from * 2:15 inch to 2:EPSON 10. See Fig. 5.2(e) in Part I.)
#PAPER = 10-G #lo-A=NEC 10 LENGTHL = 11 LENGTH = 11 WIDTHL = 10 WIDTH = 10 PITCHL = 15/l 20 PITCH = 20/l 20 LINESL = 83 LINES = 55 RATIOL = 2/3 RATIO = 2/3 GRAMODL = 14 GRAMOD = 16 ANKMODL = 0 ANKMOD = 1 LEFTMGL = 0 LEFTWG = 0 TOPMGL = 5 TOPMG = 0 LCNTC = 4 C_FILE=PRlO_A.INF RF&E = PRTDAT.DMP #lo-G=EPSON 10 LENGTHL = 11 LENGTH = 11 WIDTHL = 10 WIDTH = 10 PITCHL = 151120 PITCH = 20/l 20 LINESL = 83 LINES = 55 RATIOL = 2/3 RATIO = 213 GRAMODL = 14 GRAMOD = 16 ANKMODL = 0 ANKMOD = 1 LEFTMGL = 0 LEFTWG = 0 TOPMGL = 0 TOPMG = 0 LCNTL = 4 C-FILE = ESCPlO_A.INF OF&E = PRTDAT.DMP #15-A = 15 inch/ASCII LENGTHL = 11 LENGTH = 11 WIDTHL = 15 WIDTH = 15 PITCHL = 15/l 20 PITCH = 20/l 20 LINESL = 83 LINES = 55 RATIOL = 2/3 RATIO = 213 GRAMODL = 16 GRAMOD = 16 ANKMODL = 1 ANKMOD = 1 LEFTMGL = 0 LEFTWG = 0 TOPMGL = 0 TOPMG = 0 LCNTL = 5 C-FILE = PR 15_A.INF yE&l;E = PRTDAT.DMP II #15-G = 15 Inch
e I1 O-G = 10 Inch/graphic LENGTHL = 11 LENGTH = 11 WIDTHL = IO WIDTH = 10 PITCHL = 15/l 20 PITCH = 20/l 20 LINESL = 83 LINES = 55 RATIOL = 213 RATIO = 213 GRAMODL = 14 GRAMOD = 16 ANKMODL = 0 ANKMOD = 1 LEFTMGL = 0 LEFTWG = 0 . TOPMGL = 0 * TOPMG = 0 * LCNTL = 4 . C-FILE = PR201_10.INF $Fl;E = PRTDAT.DMP +#15-A=151nch/ASCIl LENGTHL = 11 LENGTH = 11 WIDTHL = 15 WIDTH = 15 PITCHL = 15/l 20 PITCH = 20/120 LINESL = 83 LINES = 55 RATIOL = 2/3 RATIO = 213 GRAMODL = 16 GRAMOD = 16 ANKMODL = 1 ANKMOD = 1 LEFTMGL = 0 LEFTWG = 0 . TOPMGL = 0 * TOPMG = 0 + LCNTL = 4 + C FILE = PR15 A.INF O-FILE = PRT6AT.DMP &ND + #15-G = 15 Inch .
Changing the type of printer * (The printer is changed to EPSON VP1000 and the paper is changed to lo-inch forms.)
Changing the spacing between the LADDER nets _ * [The net spacing for the LADDER diagram is widened.)
(Note)
-119-
..
4.
OPERATION
Environment
settings
for diagram
printout
- example
2 (settings
in file PR201_10.INF)
CPI
*
* *
Setting
( I~~I~~j"A): .
CANCEL CPI
LDRCPI LPI LDRLPI LMARGIN RMARGIN LDRCHAR JPNSET JPNRESET 3
(H)(W(C) (Q); (H)(W(C)(T25); (H)(W(C)(T15); (H)(W(C)(LOO5) (H)(W(C)(/O7B) (H) (1B) (C) (JO014 (H)(W(C)(Q (H)(W(C)(H);
. , . i;
(Note)
An astensk
(*) indtcates
- 120-
4.
OPERATION
Environment
l Sample
settings setting
for diagram
output
- example
file
3 (sample
setting
1 of the CROSSINF.DAT
file)
of the CROSSINF.DAT
No.
: :
0 Sample
cross reference
output
[A:\FLADDER\SAMPLE]
l l l
***
STEP NO./NET
Address x0.0 -II----#-
PAGE 1 No.
S00053/N00013
S00082/N00017
x0.1 --it-#
S00059/N00015
S00065/N00017
YO.0
Double
writing
--O--CD-:
S00045/N00009
S00128/N00062
S00256/N00098
RO.0 --It--+-
--@-
S00015/N00010 S00045/N00017
- 121-
4.
OPERATION
Environment
l
settings setting
for diagram
output
- example
file
4 (sample
setting
2 of the CROSSINF.DAT
file)
Sample
of the CROSSINF.DAT
0 Sample
cross
reference
output
PAGE 1
SO0082 SO0065
SO0088 SO0077
SO0094
Double
writing
RO.0
Read Write
SO0015
SO0022
SO0024
SO0033
SO0045
- 122-
4. OPERATION
4.5.3.6
(1) Changing
described installed
lo NEC PR201
change the setting file by means is drive of the procedure is example, the floppy disk drive A, FAPT LADDER
[Operation] OCopy the AMROFTRP.PR system floppy file from the APPENDIX directory of Volume 5 of the FAPT
LADDER-II
install directory.
Example:
C: \ CD FLADDER C: \ FLADDER
> COPY
@I Delete
the AMROPTRP.DAT
install directory.
Example:
C: \ FLADDER
> DEL
AMROPTRP.DAT
Enter >
0 Change
file to AMROPTRP.DAT.
Example:
C: \ FLADDER
> RENAME
AMROFTRP.PR
AMROPTRP.DAT
Note)
printer,
perform
steps @ through
0,
replacing
(2) Changing
to a FANUC printer
Note)
FANUC Please
PRINTER
is connected
COM1:4800,N,8.2
-123-
4. OPERATION
4.5.4 Compilation
During PMC. RAM compilatron, Uncompiled for the PMC. an edited programs source cannot program is translated into an object file executable by the or and
be transferred be performed
or FA writer) mode
Compilation (except
can
normal
condensed
mode.
PMC-PAB.)
Source program 6
I
mode program can be compiled in condensed mode. in condensed mode, mode. As a result, condensed mode area can be allocated. Normal mode Condensed Ladder
----)
Condensed
A source
When
a ladder object
listed below:
A larger C language
mode
C language
t C
language
Time required
for compilation
is reduced.
Time required
for transfer
computer
A ROM module
with a smaller
capacity
may be used.
- 124-
4. OPERATION
below.
<iI
Memory
map changes
(area expansion)
instructions,
symbols, in In
comments, condensed
and so forth are added when a ROM format file generated mode is transferred
by compilation
this case, the user needs to pay attention to possible overlap between C language area.
Ladder
&
.,. .:.
. ..
,......
C
language
b,
with
is converted order of
in ascending
numbers.
are displayed on the edit screen of the may be changed compiled, after the source
built-in programmer
or PMC-RC4 decompiled,
and downloaded.
4.5.4.1
(1) Start
[Operation]
0 @
Select [compil] (compile) from the offline menu. The compile screen appears.
Compile
Source
PMC-RB4
name
[C:~CFLADDERY
program
Output
to
ROM
format
file
[F6] (F7]
YES POINTERS
ONLY
EXEC
DOS
OEND
Fig. 4.5.4.1
(a)
-125-
4. OPERATION
General
Flow of Operation
for compiling
Offline menu
I
Fig. 4.5.4.1 (b)
Offline
menu
I
Operation and Screens
Compiling
General
(2) Compile
(a) Normal mode compile processing is always performed in condense mode.
With PMCPA3,
[Operation]
Select Compile
0
(b) Condense mode
[Operation]
Select Compile
0
(3) Displaying Pressing object The file. results of compile the results F2 [MAP]
of compile
processing
are
displayed or warning
F3 [ERROR] Moreover,
on
the
compile of
screen, compile
regardless processing
an error
output. below.
the results
lo a text-format
file, as described
C:YDATAYSAMPLE
t Output the compile result in two passes. tttC# PASS1 ##tilt MESSAGE SYMBOL LEVELl.NLA (00111net)tNet No. Ladder program exists beyond END1 instruction. in each LEVELZ.#LA subprogram. Pl.#LA PZ.#LA There is no SP instruction at the top of the subprogram. #Wt## PASS2 #tl#t
Compile completed
PASSl: PASS2:
- 126-
4. OPERATION
If many
errors
have
occurred, or by printing
those
errors
can be easily
identified
by viewing
the relevant
file
Example:
When
shown
below
is compiled,
the following
lo the
C:VDATA Execution
PMC-RB4 :C:\DATA\SAMPLE
[C:yFLADDERSr'
..::_':'::'.:$,: .:il':.",:'.' ::::I::' :,;:.:<::y::jj qij!::,:; .j: .:.(.,,:, . . '.:j:.. .." 5. ,.',::.':,,.: ;,:.:. '.. . . . Compile Rormal End ,.; :,..,..
Compile completed
error count=000000
warning count=000000
EXEC
2HAP
3ERROR
Fig. 4.5.4.1
5
(d) Complile Completed Screen
OEND
(4) DOS command You can call MS-DOS If you want to terminate shell from FAPT LADDER this, key in the command by pushing as bellow F9 (DOS) at MS-DOS key. command line.
vA:\>EXITl
(5) Termination [Operation] 0 Select [END] or press the < Esc > key.
@I The screen
drsplay
returns
screen.
- 127-
4. OPERATION
(1)
F6 [SYMBOL] Select whether output symbols or not output which the symbol & comment data to ROM format (7bytes file. or more file. symbols) and
However.the
assigned
YES: The
(Default
setting) can be displayed to them are output on CRT/MDI. on CRT/MDl(Gbytes to object file. or less symbols) and the coil
symbols
which
comments
assigned
"NO"
comment
is converted
to object
file. on CRT/MDI.
is not displayed
(2)
F7 [NETCMT] If Net comment (Note2) is output is used to object in ladder program, you can choose whether Net comment pointer
file or not.
ONLY ladder
: (Default
program
select ladder
this setting. size gets larger because Net comment pointer is output to object file.
"NO"
format
pointer
is not output
to object
ladder
However,
the object
file makes
data information
lost.
Note 1)
character
information
only
in a source
program
on the
computer. ROM format comment file does not include pointer( = information any net comment of net characters. position.) can be
comment NOP.
to ROM format
instruction
pointer that
to restore on CNC
the FAPT
is edited
LADDER.
-128-
4. OPERATION
4.5.4.3
This function It enables The
a password
to be added
password
can be used
to prohibit
CRT/MDI. options.)
This function
requires
(Refer
(1) Password
types
types. of up to 8 alphanumeric characters. consists
We
Password Password
Use
Password Password to allow display to allow display on the CNC and editing on the CNC
(R) (RAN)
(compile)
When no password
Goto@.
whether
to use a password.
Do you
enter
password?
(Y/N)
To set a password,
press l-lY I
to set a password, press
+ If password
If password +Goto@.
RW & R or R go to 0. RW go to 8.
If it is unnecessary
N l-l
- 129-
4.
OPERATION
The password
appears.
Enter password
(R)
Enter a password.
A password Uppercase
of 8 or less letters
and/or
letter is entered,
It is impossible
Some character
strings are unusable. string is entered character as a password, string. on the screen. any valid password + is specified, use of a an error message is displayed.
<Enter>
before
password
is not specified.
If password If password
= RW&R go to @. = R go to @.
When
an attempt
to specify
a password
is discontinued.
+
@I The password configuration screen appears.
GotoO.
Verification
(R)
to enter correctly.
the same
password
as entered
before,
to ensure
that your
When
password
entered
this
time
matches
one
that
was
entered
before,
it is
accepted. When they do not match, You are allowed When the message twice. to specily a password + If password = R is specified. (RW) set screen --* is discontinued. Password mismatch is displayed.
to retry entering
an attempt
GotoO. Go to @.
The password
appears.
Enter
password
(R/W)
01
(RW). that can be used is a combination of 8 or less letters and/or numerals. (If a lowercase
and lowercase
letters
l , #. and @).
is displayed.
Some
character
- 130-
4. OPERATION
An entered If the
password key
-z Enter >
before
password
When
a password -+
Go to 0.
The password
confirmation
screen
appears.
Verification
(R/W)
(9
to enter correctly.
the same
password
as entered
before,
to ensure
that your
password
entered
this
time
matches
one
that
was
entered
before,
it is
accepted. When they do not match, You are allowed the message twice. to specify a password + is rejected. Password mismatch is displayed.
to retry entering
When
the attempt
Go to 0.
@l Compilation
begins.
4.5.5
During printed
Decompilation
decomprlation, out. from the PMC or is read from ROM is object out. Such data must be decompiled file data. before Data in the object file a ROM format lile is translated into a source program that can be edited or
or printed
it can be edited
or printed
(Note)
a password-protected 4.5.4.)
object
file,
it is necessary
to enter
a password
- 131-
4. OPERATION
4.5.5.1
(1) Start
Operation
The decompile
screen
appears.
PMC-RB4 :C:\DATA\SAMPLE
[C:\FLADDER\
Output
to
Source
Program
SYMBOL h COMMENT [F4] YES Merge Duplicated symbol definition [F5] MEMORY
CARD DATA
(effective)
EXEC
MERGE
5SYMBOL6
OEND
Fig. 4.551
(a)
Decompile
Menu Screen
(2) Decompiling
Decompilation
is performed
-132-
4. OPERATION
(3) Decompiling
Upon the completion the object The result screen, file. of decompiling can be displayed by pressing the F3 [ERROR] key on the decompile of decompiling, pressing the F2 [MAP] key can display the memory map of
regardless
of whether
an error or warning
has occurred.
If many errors
have occurred,
or printed
(Example)
shown
below
is decompiled
:
are output to directory C: \ DATA.
PMC-RB4 :C:\DATA\SAMPLE
Decompile
normal
en8
Decompile
completed
error
count=000000
warning
count=000000
EXEC
MAP
3ERROR
MERGE
Fig. 4.5.5.1
SSYMBOL
(b) Decompile end Screen
OEND
(4) Termination [Operation] 0 8 Select [END]. display returns to the main menu screen.
The screen
In case source
file is specified
for output
source
program
when
decompiling,
is deleted
program
is created
of object
it is possible
the Ladder
in object
by specifying
the undermentioned
function-key.
-133-
4.
OPERATION
PMC-RB4
[C:\FLADDER\
: c: \DATA\SAMPLE
CARD DATA
(effective)
MERGE
5SYMBOL6
P
Menu Screen
OEND
Fig. 4.5.5.2
Decompile
(a) F4 [MERGE] This specification decides whether to merge the symbolicomment by NO or YES
1) "NO" :
The existent source file. of F5(SYNBOL] in this condition. program is deleted and new source program is created with the contents There of object
is no display
2) YES
: (Default
setting) in source program object is merged with that in object file. As for the other
definition
is effective,
or in object
file, when
(b) F5 [SYMBOL] F5[SYMBOL] This will be displayed decides when YES symbol is specified definition for F4(MERGE]. source program or object file is
specification
which
in either
effective
1) SOURCE
The symbol
2)
: (Default
setting)
in object
file is effective.
- 134-
4. OPERATION
of F4[MERGE]
and F5[DUPADR],
file COIL-COMMENT(30byte)
*c-
xxxxxx
YYYYYY
xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
YYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYY
R1.4
Source
- Symbol/Comment data ADDRESS SYMBOL(16byte) x0.0 Y2.3 Y4.7 AAAAAAAAAA BBBBBBBB YYYYYY
-+(i)
The result of "MERGE = NO" Source x0.0 R1.4 program xxxxxx YYYYYY xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx YYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYY
*(ii)
definition
= MEMORY
CARD
+(iii)
The result of "MERGE = YES" and "Symbol . . Source program AAAAAAAAAA AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA x0.0 BBBBBBBB BBBBBBBBBBBBBB Y2.3 YYYYYY R1.4
definition=SOURCE
DATA".
-135-
4.
OPERATION
4.553
To decompile
Password
a password-protected file, it is necessary to enter a password.
type
Password Password
I
@
Password
(R/w)
I
[EXEC] is selected, the following
Password Password
After discompilation
password
entry
screen
appears.
Enter password
(R)
Note)
(R/W)
When the valid password If the newly discontinues. (You are allowed When entered
is entered,
discompilation an error
password
is incorrect,
to retry entering
the request
-136-
4. OPERATION
455.4
When
subprograms
Object file
The END instruction is not included in the source program. The instruction is automatically when the program is compiled. added
-137-
4. OPERATION
4.5.6
There
Input/Output
are three types of inputioulput operations, as described below.
1) ROM read/write operation by the ROM writer (PMC or FA writer). 2) Transfer with the PMC RAM via an RS-232C interface.
3)
Input/output Adapter
between
card or floppy
Cassette
or Handy
File, respectively.
[Operation] 0 Switch cable. off the personal (See Appendix computer 8.) and input/output unit, and connect them via an RS-232-C
@I Start FAPT LADDER. 0 Select [l/O] (input/output) from the main menu.
@I The input/output
menu appears.
Table 4.56 Input/output ROM writers (PMC WRITER, FANUC FANUC FANUC FANUC Series Series FA WRITER) 1618/20 (PMC-R destination
series)
48OOl9600
15B (PMC-NB)
4.5.6.1
FAPT LADDER
1)
FLIO - AT.DAT So, a text editor can be used to change set values in the files.
These
-138-
4. OPERATION
2)
Contents (effective
DATA-BLOCK
PMC-WRITER FA-WRITER PMC-L PMC-M PMC-M (TT) PMC-M (AXIS) PMC-MMC PMC-MMC PMC-N PMC-P PMC-OA PMC-M (I/O) PMC-M (l/O. TT) PMC-M (I/O. AXIS) PMC-N (I/O) PMC-RB PMC-RC PMC-RAl PMC-RA2 PMC-RBP PMC-RA3 PMC-RB3 PMC-RC3 PMC-PA1 PMC-PA3 PMC-QC PMC-NB PMC-R04 PMC-RC4 PMC-RB4 PMC-RC4 (AXIS)
= IO-PORT-SET
=COMl 48.
N. 8.2 N. 8.2
=COMl =COMl =COMl =COMl =COMl =COMl =COMl =COMl =COMl =COMl =COMl =COMi =COMl =COMl =COMl =COMi =COMl =COMl =COMl =COMl =COMl =COMl =COMl =COMl =COMl =COMl =COMl =COMl
:48.N,8.2 .48, r48.N.8.2 : 48. N. 8. 2 : 48, N. 8, 2 ~48.N.8.2 r48.N.8.2 y96.N.8.2 48. N. 8. 2 : 96, N. 8. 2 : 48. N. 8. 2 .48, N. 8.2 .48. N. 8. 2 : 96. N. 8, 2 : 96, N. 8. 2 96. N. 8. 2 96. N. 8. 2 96, N. 8. 2 96. N. 8. 2 : 96, N. 8. 2 : 96. N, 8. 2 : 96, N. 0. 2 : 96, N. 8. 2 : 96, N. 8, 2 : 96. N. 8. 2 : 96, N. 8. 2 : 96, N. 8. 2 : 96, N. 8. 2 : 96, N. 8. 2 : 96. N. 8. 2
(STEP~SEO) (STEP-SEC))
=COMl =COMl
side of each equal sign ( =) : Device side of each first parameter equal (port sign (=) number)
: Represented
and second
of each rate)
MODE can be
command. changed.
(baud
- 139-
4.
OPERATION
4.5.6.2
ROM format PMC model,
ROMs Usable
lM-bit lM-bit
ROM module
A, B, C, and D
(1) Read
[Operation]
Select Fl : [FAWRT] (FA Writer) or F2 : [PMCWRT] (PMC Writer) on the l/O menu screen.
Select
Fl : (READ].
program
name
containing
read data.
Read operation
is executed.
During operation,
the indication
EXECUTING
blinks.
terminates
normally,
the indication
NORMAL
END
is output.
(2) Write
[Operation 1
Select Fl : [FAWRT] (FA Writer) or F2 : [PMCWRT] (PMC Writer) on the l/O menu screen.
Select
F2 : (WRITE].
program
name
to be written.
Writing
is executed.
During operation,
the indication
EXECUTING
blinks.
When writing
terminates
normally,
the indication
NORMAL
END
is output.
- 140-
4. OPERATION
(3) Verification
[Operation] 0 Select Fl : [FAWRT] (FA Writer) or F2 : [PMCWRT] (PMC Writer) on the I/O menu screen.
Select
F3 : [VERIFY]
program
name to be verified.
Verification
is executed.
During operatron,
the Indication
EXECUTING
blinks.
When verification
terminates
normally,
the indication
NORMAL
END
is output.
(4) Blank
check
[Operation] 0 Select Fl : [FAWRT] (FA Writer) or F2 : [PMCWRT] (PMC Writer) on the I/O menu screen.
Select
F4 : [BLANK]
(blank check).
Blank checking
is executed.
During operation,
the indication
EXECUTING
blinks.
terminates
normally,
the indication
NORMAL
END
is output.
(5) Termination
[Operation] @ Select FlO : [END].
The screen
display
returns
(Note
1)
When
writing
1Mbit
ROM
for
PMC-RB3 terminates
with
FA writer,
ID
ERROR
will
be
displayed
on FA writer. PMCRA3,
But writing
(Note 2)
PMC except
-141-
4. OPERATION
4.5.6.3
FAPT LADDER
bps
bps
for FS16/18/158,
Power
Mate-D/F/H,
Fl : [DNLOAD]
t(4) Press the CNC soft keys Press the < Enter > key. Downloading is executed.
the indication
EXECUTING END
blinks. is output.
When downloadlng
terminates
the indication
NORMAL
(2) Upload
If the PMC-RC3RC4QCNBNB2 can be used. data types When used, uploading language data (C language) other than Ladder PMCs, the programs one or comparison can be is executed from one of these and ALL
of two
(LADDER
or ALL)
specified.
LADDER
have
following
meantngs:
LADDER ALL
Sequence Sequence
program program
-142-
4.
OPERATION
Specify
described
below:
[Operation] 0 Select F3 : [PMC] on the I/O menu screen. the source program name.
@ Select
*G?JPress the CNC soft keys [PMC]. 0 Press the <Enter> key.
in this order.
Select
either
LADDER
(?I
Uploading
is executed.
During operation,
the indication
EXECUTING
blinks. ,
@I When uploading
terminates
normally,
the indication
NORMAL
END is output.
(3) Comparison
[Operation] 0 Select F3 :[PMC] on the I/O menu screen.
Select program
F3 :[COMPAR] name.
(comparison)
on
the
PMC
menu
screen
to display
the
source
$0
(PMC],
[l/O],
[HOST],
and [EXEC]
in this order
> key
6)
Comparison
is executed.
During operation,
the indication
EXECtJTlNG
blinks.
When comparison
terminates
normally,
the indication
NORMAL
END is output.
(4) Termination
The screen
dtsplay
returns
screen
(Note)
above,
an asterisk
prefixed
to a circled
number
represents
an operation
-143-
4. OPERATION
of the Power Mate-D have the CRTiMDl screen. screen and the DPL/MDI When the CRT/MD1 screen. Series The NC
screen
uploading,
and
comparison
as
described below:
(a) Press the < DGNOS (b) Press the <READ (c) Follow procedures
> or <WRITE
4.5.6.4
Memory card
card
interface
in the personal
computer
and memory
in a personal computer
can be converted
output to a memory card via a memory card interface installed in the personal computer.
program on the memory card can be sent to the RAM of the CNC by inserting the memory the memory card interface in the CNC. By reversing the procedure,
- 144-
4.
OPERATION
(1) PMC program transfer from the personal computer to the CNC [Operation]
Install a memory card interface in the personal computer.
F3 : Select
[COMPILE]
and compile
a source
program.
Return
and select
[l/O] (input/output)
from it.
Select
F5 : [M-CARD]
(memory
menu.
Fl F2 F3
FR WRITER PWC WRITER PHC Handy Clle Henorv Card BFICKUP END
F18 KEY
Fig. 4.5.6.4
(a)
InputIOutout
Menu
Select
[WRITE]
(write
(programmer
- > memory
card)).
l/O MQBRY
CARD)
Fl KEY
) )
F:!
KEY
FIO KEY
END
Fig. 4.5.6.4
(b)
Memory
Card Input/Output
Screen
- 145-
4.
OPERATION
Convert the file from source program to memory card format. Specify the following items for execution.
l
Name of the source program Display the source program name. Name of the memory card file Specify the name of a memory card file (accessible via a memory card interface in the CNC) to be created by conversion, and the drive where the memory card is inserted.
) Merry
Card
: C : YDATAWMFLE
Memory Card FILE NAME : D: YSAMPLE. #BF (Specify the MEMORYCARD drive)
Input/Output
-146-
4. OPERATION
the memory
card output
in step @ into
in the CNC and read programs of the PMC and the desired filename
on the memory
card.
READ,
or
file
number then
at press
FUNCTION,
respectively,
[EXEC]. Sequence
in step 0.
-~~ PMC l/O PROGRAM CHANNEL = 1 = M-CARD DEVICE ::FtJNC:T~I.Oti = READ DATA KIND = LADDER FILE NO. = ( #NAME ) [ EXEC I[CANCELI[WRITE I[ READ I[COMPARI MONIT STOP
at power-on
program
Refer to manual
-147-
4. OPERATION
(2)
PMC program
PMC programs
transfer
from
is inserted
in a memory
on the memory
[Operation
J
M-CARD, WRITE, DATA KIND, and the desired filename (omissible) at DEVICE, soft LADDER, Sequence and FILE NO. on the PMC l/O screen, programs are output to the memory. respectively, then press
Specify
PMC
I/O
PROGRAM
MONIT
STOP
CHANNEL = 1 = M-CARD DEVICE FHNG:TIiON: = WRITE DATA KIND = LADDER FILE NO. = ( #NAME 1
/ [ EXEC
I[CANCELl[WRITE
I[
READ
I[COMPARI
The following
operations
are performed
on the personal
computer
side.
Install a memory
card interface
in the personal
computer.
Select
[IO]
(input!output)
Select
F5 : [M-CARD]
(memory
menu,
(a).)
61
Select
[READ]
(read (programmer
<- memory
card)).
(b).)
Convert to source
l
output
to a memory
card in step 0
card format
the following
of the conversion
source
memory
card
file written
to the memory
card is inserted.
program
name.
- 148-
4. OPERATION
4.5.6.5
If a object file compiled on a personal computer is converted 3.5 floppy disk (DOS format), the PMC to the CNC. program
transfer
to the CNC
Select F4 : [FDCAS]
Select [WRITE]
(write (programmer
->
Handy File)).
FI F?
KE\ KEY
WRITE READ
( (
Programer Programner
Fig. 4.5.6.5
(a)
FDCAS
Input/Output
Screen
4. OPERATION
Name of the Handy File format file Specify the name to be assigned to the Handy File format file (accessible File) to be generated by conversion, by the Handy
)
C:YSAMPLE. #SF
: C: YDATAYSAMFLE drive)
Fig. 4.5.6.5
(b)
Input/Output
(to FDCAS)
Screen
Connect the CNC and Handy File, and insert the 3.5 floppy disk generated the Handy File.
in step @ into
transfer
[Operation] 0 Connect the CNC and Handy File, and output the PMC program to a 3.5 floppy disk (DOS format).
side.
@I Select [READ]
(read (programmer
(a).)
- 151-
4.
OPERATION
Convert source
l
disk (Handy
File format)
generated
in step 0
to
by specifying
the utility.
output
in step 0,
floppy
disk drive
where
the
READ
I Prograr
I~ Handy File
Handy File File naw (Specify the floppy disk Source program naiw
Fig. 4.5.6.5
(c)
InputlOutput
(from FDCAS)
Screen
Decompile
the source
program
able
to be edited
on the personal
computer.
-152-
4.
OPERATION
4.5.6.6
This backup program Please
tl t2 FlB
Fig. 4.5.6.6
(a)
Backup
Menu Screen
(1) Backup
Select
Fl : [BACKUP]
menu.
Enter a backup
program
name,
and press
(EXEC].
BRCKUP (SOURCE
PROGRRH ->
RRCKUP PROGRAM)
BRCKUP PROGRRW NW
mrmm3m3amm3mnm
Fig. 4.5.6.6 (b) Backup Screen
-153-
4.
OPERATION
normaly,
the NORMAL
END
message
is displayed.
[Operation]
@I Select [BACKUP] from the input/ output menu.
(3
Select
F2 : [RESTOR]
menu.
Enter a backup
program
name,
Fig. 4.5.6.6
(c)
Restoring
Screen
@I When restoring
terminates
normaly,
the NORMAL
END
message
is displayed.
-154-
4. OPERATION
4.5.7
This function
Specified
data is stored
program.
[Operation
j
the cursor to the function for which options are to
On the setting
screen
for each
function,
select
an item by positioning
the cursor
with the
the setting
.\DRTA\SFlnPLE
Fig. 4.57
457.1
Compile
function options options as described below. These options, when set, are
The user can set the compile used as the initial values
of the compile
function,
or are used
for compile
processing
performed
functions.
For details
of each option,
see Section
4.5.4.
(1)
Condense This option specifies whether condense mode is to be used for compile processing.
(2)
Symbol This option specifies whether to output symbol or comment data to an object file.
(3)
Net comment This option specifies whether to output net comment data to an object file.
-155-
4. OPERATION
(4) Password
This option specifies whether to display the password setting dialog box at compile time.
VW
[RW&R]
the dialog
box.
(Password
setting
is disabled.)
Displays password
the
password
(RN) box.
setting
dialog
box
as well
as the
(R) setting
dialog
Fw [RI
Displays
(RAN) setting
dialog
box.
Displays
(R) setting
dialog
box.
Fig. 4.5.7.1
-156-
4.
OPERATION
4.5.7.2
Decompile
function options function functions. 4.5.5. as described decompile below. options, These options, when set, are
The user can set the decompile used as the initial values processing For details performed
of the off-line
of each option,
(1) Symbol
merge specifies whether to merge source program data and object file symbol/comment
This option
data at decompile
time.
PJOI [SOURCE]
. T
symbol
to the source
program
[MEMORY
CARD]
Gives
priority
to the object
duplicate
addresses file.
exist
in
the source
program
IDecomDilel ~~INO/SOURCE~I
Fig. 4.5.7.2
-157-
4. OPERATION
4.5.7.3
(OPTION.CNF)
can be modified by means of
of each option
described
[Operation]
Using the text editor, II is installed. open the OPTION.CNF file under the directory where FAPT LADDER-
corresponding
to a model
subject
to initial value
modification
Example:
#32;(RA3)
#4l;(Rl34_STEP)
Note)
A section attempt
having
a line
beginning
with
a semicolon
(:) contains
legend
data.
Any
to modify
such a section
is ignored.
corresponding
to a function
subject
to initial
value
modification
(that is,
with ).
Specify
a new value
whose
initial value
is to be modified.
Table 4.5.7.3 Subsection COMPILE condense Option 0: 1: Performs mode. Performs mode. Setting compile compile and function processing processing in normal in condense
symbol (Symbol/comment)
0: 1:
Does not output symbol/comment data to the object file. Outputs symbol/comment data to the object file. Does not output net comment data to the object file. Outputs net comment data to the object file. Does Sets Sets Sets not set a password. a password (R/W) and password a password (RMT). a password (R).
0: 1:
password
0: 1: 2: 3: 0: 1: 2:
(R).
DECOMPILE
symbol-merge
Does not perform merge processing. Performs merge processing with priority given to source program data. Performs merge processing with priority given to object file data.
Note)
Never
attempt
to modify
the values
of options
in the above
table.
Otherwise,
the system
may malfunction.
-158-
4. OPERATION
4.5.8 4.5.8.1
The mnemonic
(a)).
SOURCE PROGRAM-) WEUINIC FILE MNEWNIC FILE ) SOURCE PROGRAM EXECUTEUSER BATCH FILE END
Fig. 4.5.8.1(a)
Mnemonic
Menu Screen
Select [MNECNV]
(conversion to mnemonic).
-159-
4.
OPERATION
@I The mnemonic
conversion
screen
appears
(Fig. 4.5.8.1(b)).
I) SOURCEPROGRAMNM(E 2) WEMUNIC FILE NAME 31 CUNVfRTADI)TA KIND SELECTIUN (0 { ; : yqgl PARAMETER (3 4) MODE SwBULLCMMENr : 4 , 5 . 6 : LADDER : I/U MODULE MESSECE P-C
: FUR
Fig. 4.5.8.1
(b)
Mnemonic
Conversion
Screen
Specify
l
Source Display
Mnemonic Specify
the name
of Ihe mnemonic
file to which
a source
program
is converted.
Up to
40 characters
l
can be specified. selection to conversion. All data files can be specified or specific data
(setting setting
item selection) items. Select items from the table below, using the -z t > and
> keys.
- 160-
4. OPERATION
:OR - P-G
format
(Note 3). data, which may include address symbols kanji characters, and comments, is converted. and function instruction
IJLL - OPTIONS
(Note 3). is converted JMPC, and the jump destination (label) of a function used instruction is not
(JMPB,
CALL, step
highlighted. agree
The
mnemonic section
with other
setting.
(The function
in the sub-
of a Japanese-language
message
to Japanese-language
(Note 3).
(Note 1) (Note 2, 3)
The item
specifying mode
Japanese system.
language
comment
conversion
cannot
be selected
displayed editing.
on the code
or Japanese-language
input
mode
screen
during
Select
[EXEC]
upon completion
of item specification.
Source
program
is converted
to a mnemonic
file.
An error conversion
message screen
if <Enter>
is pressed
after
conversion.
The
mnemonic
after conversion.
-161-
4. OPERATION
4.5.8.2
A mnemonic program
of FAPT LADDER.
The mnemonic
menu screen
appears.
Select
[SRCCNV]
(conversion
to a source
program).
The source
program
conversion
screen
appears
(Fig. 458.2).
I)
WEMONIC
FILE PROCRAM
NAMT NAME
2) SOURCE
Specify
l
the followlng
items:
Source Display
program
Select
[EXEC]
upon completion
of item specification.
Mnemonic
file is converted
to a source
program
An error program
message conversion
is displayed screen
if
c Enter> when
is pressed
after
conversion.
The
source
appears
after conversion.
-162-
4. OPERATION
4.5.8.3
program, the mnemonic file must be in the following format. (1) Identification code codes that each begin with %.
Description Beginning of ALL-format data End of ALL-format data Beginning of unit-format data End of unit-format data
The unit-format data mentioned above varies from one PMC model to another as listed below. I PMC model Unit-format data R series/PAS/QC/NB/NB2 Parameter Title Symbol & comment Ladder Message l/O module
%@O %@l
FORMAT-A/B FORMAT-C This means that, as part of conversion type code is performed. and %@2-C) to
FAPT LADDER-II uses FORMAT-C only. a mnemonic file, conversion used. to %@2-C to a source program, however,
-163-
4.
OPERATION
(3) Reserved
symbols
This special
l
cd
character
is reserved
data.
to separate are treated program, ladder data from a as a comment. a semicolon and
A semicolon comment.
file is converted
back to a source
that follows
it are not generated. for use in ladder and l/O module data. from ladder
r:j
This special
l
character
is reserved
A colon data.
is used in the ladder data section Data that precedes is also from used a colon is treated
to separate
a net number
in the
I/O module
data.
precedes
is treated
number.
character character $ is used as control character in the mnemonic file. file. Every dollar
dollar
character
in the sentence
must be described
as $$I
in the mnemonic
(a) Symbol
and comment
data
(f)
and symbol data and the symbol strings in a same line. describe after address data
strings
as delimitter.
R0200.0
UNIT - 3 - POWER
-164-
4.
OPERATION
I $1 KEEP POWER ON
KEEP UNIT-3
POWER
ON
Blank character
or horizontal tabulation character Mark of comment data line (only $1) by double
must be described
$1
INITIALIZE
OF SEQUENCE
Note)
string must be
Description of net comment The net comment data is specified by ( and ) characters.
31
Designation Designation
of new page (for ladder diagram printing) of new page for ladder diagram printing must be described file. as $P or $p in
the mnemonic
-165-
4. OPERATION
4.5.8.4
%@ 0 2 3 4
2. Counter 3. Whether
4.
PMC model
81 [EOBI (Note)
When specifying the YES in Item 3 above LED address, (whether
specify as
KEY address,
KEY image
address
follows:
(3
@ PMC-RB3
ROOlOl
(100% (fixed))
%l IEOBI (Note)
When specify address specifying the KEY YES in Item LED 3 above address, (whether KEY an image operators address, panel and is used), image
address,
LED
as follows:
3 YES X0000
-166-
4. OPERATION
PMCRC3IRC4IRC4
(STEP)
se
2 3 4 5 7
1
2. Counter
3. 4. Whether data type an operators (Binary panel is used or BCD) (YES: Used, NO: Not used)
PMC model
(PMCRC3/PMCRC4/PMCRC4 (STEPSEQ))
5.
Start address
of language
program
link control
statement
data
%l IEOBI
7. Ladder YES execution in Item LED time 3 above address,
to SFFFFF
(Note)
operators address,
panel and
is used), image
address,
LED
as follows:
3 YES X0000
PMCQC/NB/NB2
se
2 3 4 5 6 7
to 2FFFFF
sl [EOBI
(Note) If YES
time
(1% to 99% 1
7. Ladder execution
(Always
100%)
is specified
in item
3 (whether
an operators
panel as follows:
is used),
specify
the
addresses
-167-
4.
OPERATION
11
MACHINE MACHINE CNC PMC EDITION PROGRAM DATE PROGRAM ROM REMARKS1 WRITTEN OF 7 PMC TOOL TOOL NAME1 NO.1 NO.1 DRAWING PROGRAMING1 DESIGNED BY1 BYi NO.1 BUILDER NAME1 NAME 1
PROGRAM
[EOB]
%@2-c R0200.0
rp UNIT-3-POWER
Symbol
'KEEP UNIT-3 I
Relay comment
POWER ON'
Coil Comment
R0200.1
$1 *$'PowER$$' R0300.0 $1
ON'
code
'KEEP INIT-
POWER ON'
PO008
INITIALIZE 'INITIALIZE
no Relay comment
OF SEQUENCE'
-168-
4.
OPERATION
Q) FULL- OPTIONS
%@3
1
SUB 71 Pl ; SP
NOOOOl:
r)1
Symbol r
Relay comment 1
;(SUBPRl :
[SUB PROGRAM
DATA NO.Ol] 1 Coil comment LOOl" 4-_1 no Comment no Relay comment LOOl" 1
N00002:
RD SUB
x0.0 68 LlOO
) "JUMPB LABEL
[LABEL ~ooooi] I1
N00003:
RD SUB
x0.1 73 LlOO
) "JUMPB LABEL ) 1
[LABEL ~ooool] 1 1 )l
N00004:
SUB
69 LlOO
;(LABELl
[LABEL ~ooooi] 1 1
N00005: N00006:
SUB SUB
72 71 P2
i- SPE ;
spl
) "SUB PROGRAM DATA NO.l"l
N00007:
RD DEC
RO.0 DO 21 DO.0 72 64
1 1 1
)
1 : SPE 1 : END 1
-170-
4. OPERATION
LABEL/SUB-PROGRAM
8@3
Address
Relay comment
SUBPRl
SP
SUBPRl r
;<Pl
Symbol
> SUB
-
XADRSZ LABEL1
[LABEL LOOOOl] 1
1 ;<P2 RADROO DADR04 ;<RO.O ;<DO > "SUB PROGRAM ' ' NO.l"l
1 1
21
WRT SPE END 01 1 1 DO.0 1
(4
Message
%@
A0
4
0.
1
0
DOOR
NOT SPEED
CLOSE1 ARRIVA
AOO.l L SIGNAL
A00.2
KEY
SWITCH
ONJ.
%l IEOBI
0)
I/O module
%@ 5 1
x000
1 1
0 0
1 4
ID64AJ. OD64Bl
YOO8
sl
[EOBI
- 171-
4. OPERATION
458.5
TOOL BUILDER
NAME1
-10 REMARKS 1 %1 %@2-c 1 R0200.0 UNIT-3-POWER1 'KEEP UNIT-3 POWER ON'1 $1 'KEEP POWER ON' R0200.1 UNIT-2-ACT1 'KEEP UNIT-~ SSPOWERS' ON'1 $1 'S'POWERSS' R0300.0 1 'KEEP UNIT-4 POWER ON'J. $1 'KEEP POWER ON' OPEN-FRONT1 PO008 $1 'OPEN FRONT COVER' 1 INITIALIZE1 LO100 'INITIALIZE OF SEQUENCE'1 $1 " %
%@3
RD RlOOl.01 OR R120.3 1 AND R1000.2 1 WRT Y2000.4 1 (* Any characters Inscribe the net comment here. A Net comment which are input with personal computer can be used. 1) RD R1OO1.O 1 AND R1000.2 1 WRT Y23.4 1 form feed position (in Ladder diagram printing) 1* SP l) RD R1O1.O 1 OR R123.4 1 AND R100.21 WRT Y200.4 1 % 1 %@4 1 AOO.0 2100020 ATC DOOR NOT DLOSEJ AOO.l 2101022 SPINDLE SPEED ARRIVAL SIGNAL NOT ON 1 % 1 %@5 1 x000 1 0 1 ID16CI YOO8 1 0 4 OD32A1
1 %@E 1
%
-172-
4. OPERATION
4.5.8.6
by means of mnemonic-to-source
2) Source-to-Mnemonic
If source-to-mnemonic subprograms step
Conversions for a step sequence step sequence source program, only ladder being ignored. conversion, then If a to
to mnemonics,
subprograms
sequence
program
is subjected
to source-to-mnemonic
mnemonic-to-source
conversion,
PMCRC3 1 PMCRC4
J PMCRC4
1 (STEP SEQ)
A program (STEP
(STEP
SEC)) cannot
be converted
SEC)
to use mnemonics
for step
sequence.
converted 3.)
- 173-
4. OPERATION
4.5.8.7
own
batch
file generated
by editing
the contents
of the FLMNE.BAT
Example
The execution
of FAPT LADDER
is suspended variable
VZ is activated.
VZ must be defined
in the environment
PATH beforehand.)
[Operation]
Use a standard text editor to create the batch file FLMNE.BAT as follows:
vz
Select
MNEEDT
(mnemonic
editing)
The mnemonic
menu screen
appears.
Select
([BATCH]
(user batch
file execution).
The following
message
appears:
Execute Add
FLMNE.BAT.
parameter(s)?
[A(Add),
N(Not
add),
S(Stop)]
Specify
A (Add),
and specify
*.HEX
as the parameter.
VZ is activated
.HEX is displayed.
To restart
FAPT LADDER,
terminate
VZ.
The screen
display
returns
to the mnemonic
menu
screen.
Example
The
execution
of
FAPT
LADDER
is
suspended. commands
Then,
the
command Create
processor as
COMMAND.COM follows:
is activated
and MS-DOS
are enabled.
FLMNE.BAT
COMMAND
-174-
4.
OPERATION
4.5.9
Selecting functions
Utility
(UTILTY] from the off-line at installation: menu enables the use of the utility functions. The following
are registered
Moving
line (starting
COMMAND.COM)
<Fl>:
DOS
between
computer
(FLOADAT)
c F2 > : floadat
see Section
Referencing
the results
of compile
or decompile
processing
Link function
and 0
are detailed
below. any desired command 2. as a utility. For an explanation of how to perform this 2.1 of Appendix
see Section
(1) Referencing
the results
of compile
or decompile or decompile
(starting
FLVIEW.BAT) result using file and map file a commercially even before
of text
format,
By using is terminated.
this function,
however,
FAPT LADDER
Then,
shown
below
appears.
These
be referenced
by
pressing
$P. :.er C .. :.... ..::i..l::>. .j: ..+ The user can specify (.err: Execution result the type of files to be referenced, filei.map: Map file). simply by changing the file name extension
4. OPERATION
(2)
Link
linking, can
created with
in the C language
file.
The C is not
PMCRC3RC4RC4
SEQ)IQCINBINB2.
Linking
is not used.
U
l
U 1 II
ROM format file
Load modules fn C language
Transferred
andPMC
(Note 1)
enables an object
on a personal
computer.
In addition, transferred
with to
language
can be separately
C proqram
development
environment
for PMC-RC
(IRC3IRC4IQCINB)
Personal
C language
source
Link control
iC286 (compiler)
I ,tt
BND386 BLD386 OJ386 (binder) t (binder) $_ (converter
FANUC library
distribution
)
_ HEX2SREC (Note l)-
Convert (Note 2) Link _ROM format file -Object file (MCARD file) with C language
--
I-I-
.I
-176-
4.
OPERATION
(Note
l)FAPT
load modules
Before
(Note
2)With
format
be created
IA:\FLADDER\APPENDIX>
HEx2sREc
input-file-name
output-file-name
Conversion is performed.
@I Check that specified file names have been created using the DIR command.
SAMPLE.SR)
(Note)
When
is omitted,
.HEX
is is in
assumed. changed
is directed
The specification
input/output:
HEXZSREC HEXZSREC HEXZSREC HEXZSREC SAMPLE.HEX SAMPLE SAMPLE.SR
SAMPLE.SR
SAMPLE.HEX SAMPLE
(b) Converting
Conversion
Conversion
file)
-177-
4. OPERATION
G3 Select
menu.
is displayed.
(Note)
does
not display
information
relating
to the
c F9 > key,
but the
< F9 >
select
Fl [WRITE] select
to convert F2 [READ]
file (MCARD
Fl F2
KEV KEY
WRITE ( Memory Card -> ROM FORMAT FILE 1 AEFlO ( Memory Card <- ROM FORMAT FILE 1 END
F10 KEY
-178-
4.
OPERATION
(c) Starting
link processing
GZJ Then,
the pop-up
screen
shown
below
appears.
Pressing
the
<Enter>
key displays
the
link screen.
Specify
by changing between
the model
the PMC
models
PMC model
Model
Linker
Load
wdule
A:YDATAYC-WDULE.
SR
bchlne
NC d WC na.e
Link Screen
-179-
4.
OPERATION
(Note)
If an
invalid model file is spectfted, the status line of the link screen does not display a In such a case, check the following:
model name.
When the newly entered file name is invalid + Enter a valid file name.
When the specified model file is not installed --* Install the model file.
(d) Linking
[Operation] m Specify the load module file name and ROM format file name to link. name must conform to DOS specifications. (--------.
l
The load module file file name program should be name for
specified
HEX2SREC.)
Select [EXEC].
(3) Termination
4.5.10 Selecting
Selecttng ON-LINE
program) functions.
(Correct LADDER
of a ROM
format
from FAPT
3 CONVERSION
OF SEQUENCE
[Present] (1) Select appears. ]Off-Line Function] from the initial menu, then select F6 [l/O]. The [l/O] screen
[Correctron] (5) Select appears. [Off-Line Function] from the initial menu, then select [l/O]. The [l/O] screen
- 180-
4. OPERATION
4.6 4.6.1
4.6.1.1
The signal on-line
statuses
Onscreen
monitoring
of ladder
programs
Online editing
of ladder
programs
Display
and modification
of PMC parameters
Onscreen
monitoring
and modification
of signal statuses
of a program
to
Writing to F-ROM
[Note]
The on-line options:
The on-line
monitoring
function
of a step sequence
program
is not supported.
function
can be selected
menu
by selecting
either
of the following
two
ON-LINE
FUNCTION
ON-LINE
(SELECTED
PROGRAM)
are outlined
below:
- 181 -
4.
OPERATION
this option
subsequently
monilor
and modify
the ladder
,----
CNCiPMC
1 Sequence
I
program
(RAM) ON
1
I
Sequence
program
(RAM)
I
01
1 Sequence
7 Power program
On-line function *IB, Diagnosis . lnputioutput (Loading from or storing to the PMC, writing to FROM) Communication (Communication with the PMC)
(F-ROM)
1
I
J @
File storage
-182-
4. OPERATION
(b)
ON-LINE
(SELECTED
menu of the PMC and to monitor and modify the ladder program and signal statuses. This function enables computer. This function enables the ladder monitor/online edit function to be applied SELECT]. to a relay a ladder program, held by the PMC, to be loaded into a personal
- FAPT LADDER-II
1, (SELECTED
CNUPMC
0
A sequence program held on the PMC is compared with the sequence program specified on the personal computer (automatic). < If the programs do not match > Select one of the following monitoring methods: . Loading of the program from the PMC . Storing of the program to the PMC . Respecifying the program on the personal computer Continuing or stopping the processing Ladder monitor Sequence r
Sequence
@1
1 Sequence
t
program (RAM)
On-line function . Diagnosis 2@ . Input/output (Loading from or storing to the PMC. writing to FROM)
. Communication
with the PMC)
(Communication
File B
- 183-
4. OPERATION
4.6.1.2
function,
select
ON-LINE
FUNCTION
or ON-LINE FUNCTION
PROGRAM) on the initial menu screen. The operation of the function (SELECTED PROGRAM) partly depends on whether ON-LINE For details is selected. of the subsequent operation,
RBO(STEP SEQ)
[ C:YDATRYSAWLE I
Version 01.0
ROBE-9201-3503
Press [TABI key to move the cursor and press [ENTERI or [SPRCEI key to select.
bff-Line Function
I I
Exit
(Note)
- 184-
4.
OPERATION
FUNCTION is selected, performing monitor the following displayed, function steps causes select key. the ladder function monitor either
FUNCTION
screen
a desired
from a pull-down
the corresponding
[Displaying
the ladder
monitor
Select
ON-LINE
FUNCTION.
. .
.. . . .
See Section
4.6.6,
Communication.
A program
is loaded
4.6.5.1,
(This step is executed J The ladder subproaram monitor screen J Select a subproqram.
. . .
..
. .
.. .
appears
(automatic).
. _. . . . .
screen appears.
. .
J
The ladder monitor
1
Ladder sections.
See Section
4.6.4.1,
monitor.
The screens
are outlined
below.
For details,
-185-
4. OPERATION
with the PMC ON-LINE FUNCTION dialog box) to appear causes the online below. monitor Communication screen (SET
as shown
Try
to
connect
with
PllC
0000 0000
F7 Splist
FB Search
F9 Symbol
Fl@ Seting
Fig. 4.6.1.2
(b)
(Note)
button
communication Communication.)
the settings.
(See Section
- 186-
4. OPERATION
from the PMC with the PMC starts normally, the SET COMMUNICATION dialog A
communication automatically
FROM PMC
dialog
box is opened
in its place.
is automatically
Lid
-Transfer . LADDER data
ftom
PNC
..,
type 0 ALL
Fig. 4.6.1.2
(Note)
recently
monitored
program
(c)
dialog
box (Ladder
monitor
to be monitored
in the dialog
the cursor
subprogram
by pressing
the
The ladder
diagram
subprogram
appears.
LEVECl LEVEL2 PO0001 PO0002 P00010 PO0011 PO0021 PO0022 (OPEN RIGHT DOOR (OPEN LEFT DOOR (GRIP WORK PIECE (PUT WORK PIECE ) ) ) )
PICK UP A WORK ON THE STAND PUT DOWN A WORK MOVE RIGHT DOOR TO LIMIT-SWTH-R2 MOVE LEFT DOOR TO LIMIT-SWTH-L2
Ok
11 Cancel]
Fig. 4.6.1.2
(d)
- 187-
4. OPERATION
program PROGRAM) on-line is selected after a program the program is obtained using the the
of the
function,
but before
is decompiled,
message
appears:
IMemory
card
format
file
has
been
updated.
Decompile
it
? (Y/N)
function
obtained
function,
type Y.
see Appendix
6)
Selecting When
a monitoring communication
method with the PMC starts normally is compared below after ON-LINE (SELECTED If
is selected,
program
box shown
appears.
a desrred
[LOAD]
: : : :
A program is overwritten.
is loaded
program
[STORE]
program
is stored already
to the PMC.
The selected
program
on the PMC.
[SELECT] [CONTINUE]
display
The on-line
function
N:E-3160 1 Load
Selected 1 Load
Store
program from
to
is
not
same.
memory. memory.
IStore)
On-Line
Fig. 4.6.1.2
(Note)
program
the program
This occurs,
of off-line
editing
is started Instead.
or stored,
the
appear.
screen
appears
immediately.
- 189-
4.
OPERATION
PMC statuses,
using
Icons
at the right
end of the
(a) Display
positions
Displayed of icon
1. File 2. Diagnose 3, l/o 4. ~OmWniCakiOn
position
I t t 000 r
Fig. 4.6.1.2
(f)
Fig. 4.6.1.2
(g)
(2,
Ladder
executron
The following
icon indicates
(h)
icon rndrcates
a communication
Fig. 4.6.1.2
(i)
-190-
4. OPERATION
4.6.1.3
Menus
figure shows the menu configuration of the on-line function. For details of each
sections.
On-line
function
-1
I. File
-_; !. Diagnose
Ladder
Monitor
(on-line
Editor)
PMC Parameter
status
I:
Counter
the ladder
Information
Fig. 4.6.1.3
Menu Configuration
4. OPERATION
4.6.2
Preparation
attempting to use the on-line function, make the following preparations:
Before
Connect
computer
via an RS232C
cable.
(4.6.2.1)
($1 Check
(4.6.2.2
to 4.624)
4.6.2.1
Connect Specify
the
MONITOR
of the PMC.
the cable
is connected specify
specify
for CHANNEL.
is connected
to RS232-2,
2 for CHANNEL.
192-
4. OPERATION
4.6.2.2
The
Parameter
parameters screen. for
MONITOR causes
Pressing monitor
the on-line
parameter
PARAMETER
FOR
ONLINE
MONITOR = ,. .,.
MONIT
RUN
CPU ID RS-232C CHANNEL BAUD RATE PARITY STOP BIT TIMER 1 TIMER 2 TIMER 3 MAX PACKET
= &Q/NOT
=
USE
RS-232C=INACTIVE
EMG ST
INIT
Fig. 4.6.2.2
(a)
[Note] 1.
using
the g-inch
CRT
screen,
MONITOR to another
using Up>
[Note] 2.
is necessary screen.
the parameter
MONITOR
- 193-
4. OPERATION
4.6.2.3
Modifying parameters
Some of the parameters can be modified by the cursor on screen moved by the cursor keys, and some of them can modified by entering number or characters with the cursor on them. [INIT] Soft key [INIT] initializes all these parameters to the default value. have to modify any initial parameters, BAUD RATE parameters at least. however, In most case, you dont and you should confirm the CHANNEL
BAUD
RATE,
PARITY
BIT
must
correspond with the parameters used by On-Line Function of FAPT LADDER, which dialog box of Communication of the parameters And these used in [LOJ screen which can be monitor driver next starts USE for the RS-232C This
changed on [SPEED] screen. becomes valid when the on-line specify NOT modifying a parameter,
parameter to stop the on-line monitor driver. operation validates the modified parameter.
4.6.2.4
When using the on-line function to connect a personal computer to the PMC, first start the on-line monitor driver that provides the communication parameter on the parameter monitor driver. Setting function of the PMC. The setting of the RS232C the operation monitor driver. of the on-line The driver screen of the on-line monitor controls starts the on-line
occupies the line specified in the CHANNEL parameter and enters the wait state. PMC and personal computer can be connected. When the on-line monitor driver starts, the status indication from INACTIVE TO STAND-BY. RS232C = INACTIVE 1 RS-232C = STAND-BY Conversely, setting the RS232C : 21 : 0
parameter to NOT USE stops the on-line monitor driver. to the personal computer. Another input/output
In this can
function
of the on-line monitor driver. If the parameter monitor is pending, computer, the on-line
Once the on-line monitor driver stops, the status indication is set to NOT USE while the PMC is connected STOPPING is displayed as the status. The following statuses can be displayed:
changes to INACTIVE.
While disconnection
- 194-
4. OPERATION
Status indication INACTIVE STOPPIMG The on-line The on-line computer STARTING STAND-BY CONNECTED
monitor
driver
monitor monitor
interface
function
DISCONNECTED
normally.
NO CONNECTION
The cable
is not connected.
[EMG ST] Pressing whether terminated the ]EMG ST] soft key immediately is currently established. stops the on-line this key condrtions. monitor if the driver irrespective cannot of be
Use
connection
because
of abnormal
communication
[Note] 1.
of the on-line
monitor
driver, turned
starts driver
the CNC
is subsequently
line while
it is operating.
In this state,
inputioutput 2.
functions
monitor [EDIT],
driver
[SYSPRM].
4.6.2.5
Starting and stopping the on-line monitor function (Only for Power Mate-H)
monitor function to connect function a personal computer to the PMC, first start the or stopping the driver,
the communication
of the PMC.
When starting
It is necessary
to set either
of the following
parameters.
Parameter Parameter
screen
for on-line
monitor
(PARAMETERS
MONITOR)
RS-232-C
: :
On-line On-line
monitor monitor
[Note]
is necessary screen.
when
the parameter
FOR
MONITOR
Bit 6 of parameter
Mate-H
4. OPERATION
#7
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#f
#6
#6 = 0 : On-line
monitor monitor
driver driver
1 : On-line
When either
of the following
conditions
consists,
the driver
is started.
0
l
Parameter
RS-232-C
Bit 6 of parameter
No. 0101
[Note] 1.
The on-line
monitor
driver
occupies
the line while it is operating. cannot line, use the line. to display the above-
it is necessary driver.
monitor
monitor
functions
cannot
be used.
[PMCLADJ, [EDIT],
[l/O),
[EDIT],
and [SYSPRM]
on CRT/MDI.
[SYSTEM
PARAM],
on DPLIMDI.
4.6.3 4.6.3.1
(1) Menu
To activate menu.
[ 1, File] menu,
and select
[File save]
on the
Il.
File Fiie
Function
Fig. 4.6.3.1
(a)
-196-
4. OPERATION
Program
name
I SAMPLE c
C: Y DATA%
to be
Save program
Close diaglog
box
Fig. 4.6.3.1
(b)
(3) Operation
(a) Pressing @
is saved
an existing below,
program prompting
box, shown
appears,
: :
Overwrite
this program
Fig. 4.6.3.1
(c)
- 197-
4.
OPERATION
When
the contents
of an edited
program
preserved
by selecting
F7
[UPDATE] The
on the on-line edit function (See Section 4.6.4.1, operation becomes invalid.
File save
Press the < Enter > or -z Esc > key to close the dialog box.
IN.E -
3158
Ladder
diagram
has
been
modified.
Fig. 4.6.3.1
(d)
button
The specified file is not saved, and the dialog box closes.
4.6.3.2
The Off-Line Function.
(1) Menu
positlon Function, pull down [I. File] menu, and select [Off-Line
Function] on the
4.6.3.3
Exit
(1)
Menu
position
1.
Off-Line
- 198-
4. OPERATION
(2) Dialog
box view
Are
you
sure
you
want
to
exit
Fig. 4.6.3.3
(b)
(3) Operation (a) Push [OK] button. Online function ends lnitfal Menu appears. For details, see Section (4.6.4.1 Ladder Monitor)
When
modifications
made
by executing
File
fl
saved, is displayed.
Save
changes
? pq
Fig. 4.6.3.3
(c)
[Yes] [No]
: :
[Cancel]
Cancel to [Exit]
- 199-
4.
OPERATION
When
there
are on the
any
which File
have save
not
been
preserved is canceled.
by
[UPDATE] following
online
operation
dialog
box appears.
been
modified
Fig. 4.6.3.3
(d)
[Yes]
by on-line
editor
is canceled
and On-Line
Function
[No]
Cancel
to [Exit].
4.6.4
Diagnose
menu contains the menu Items as shown below.
12. Diagnose]
Lddder
Monitor
PMC Status Signal Status + PMC Parameter PMC alarm status RUN/STOP the ladder System Information
Ladder Monitor/Online Editor window PMC Status window Signal status window sub-menu of PMC Parameter windows PMC alarm message dialog box RUNSTOP the ladder dialog box System Information dialog box
-2oo-
4.
OPERATION
1.
File
[Level
Signal Status + PMC Parameter PMC alarm status RUN/STOP the ladder
L
NET
00001-00006
DO I ROOOO.O
-IL
SUB END1 1
DO
SUB END2
'SUB END
64
F7
FB
F9
FlO
Setinc
Fig. 4.6.4.1
(a)
- 202 -
4.
OPERATION
(b) Ladder
monitor
Moving
the cursor
to the
selecting
a subprogram
Symbol
Displaying the symbol or comment defined at a specified address Switching between ladder monitor and on-line editing, switching between symbol display and comment display
F9 : [Symbol]
(e)
Setting
FlO : [Setting]
(f)
(c)
Selecting A ladder
a subprogram program
is monitored
list existing
subprograms
and to select
the subprogram
to be displayed.
- 203 -
4.
OPERATION
list display
screen causes a window to be displayed, a cursor key as shown or the below. > key Select then the the
F7 (SpList]
to be displayed
by pressing
<Page
[Note]
The on-line
monitoring
function
program
is not supported.
The subprogram
of a step sequence
is not selected.
Sub*program
,list-
rJimLZ LEVEL2 PO0001 PO0002 SPOOOlO PO0011 PO0021 PO0022 (OPEN RIGHT DOOR (OPEN LEFT DOOR (GRIP WORK PIECE (PUT WORK PIECE (CLOSE RIGHT ) ) ) ) MOVE RIGHT DOOR TO LIMIT-SWITH-Rl MOVE LEFT DOOR TO LIMIT-SWITH-Ll
PICK UP A WORK ON THE STAND PUT DOWN A WORK MOVE RIGHT DOOR TO LIMIT-SWTH-R2 MOVE LEFT DOOR TO LIMIT-SWTH-L2
DOOR) )
Fig. 4.6.4.1
(b)
Display
The following
LEVEL1 LEVEL2
Ladder (No mark) Step Sequence (S mark) -
PO0001 PO0002
(OPEN RIGHT DOOR) MOVE RIGHT DOOR TO LIMIT-SWITH-Rl (OPEN LEFT DOOR) MOVE LEFT DOOR TO LIMIT-SWITH-Ll (GRIP "OR; PIECE) PICK UP ~A WORK ON THE STAND
_IpPOOOIO1
I
Symbol Sub-program No. Fig. 4.6.4.1 (c)
I
Coil comment
(d) Searching
the search
data (<Shift
>
+ <F8>)
ii>
Searching A search
for data (F8 [SEARCH]) for a net starts when the < FB> key is pressed after the search data has
been entered. If the < F8> key is pressed without specifying any search data data, a search is made for
Entering types
search
of data, as described
- 204
4. OPERATION
@Address/symbol Searching Searching for an address: for a symbol: instruction address symbol + < F8> + <F8> Example) Example) X0000.0 SYMBOLI + < F8 > + < F8 >
lFunctional
Searching
for a number:
Searching
for a name:
functional-instruction-name
lNet number:
0 Entering search data (< Shift >
net-number
+ < F8 >
Example)
IO + < F8 >
+ < F8 >) by means for identical box appears. press the c Tab > key. To change the setting, of operation data, 0, described above, While can this
To position
the cursor
to another
. Data
. @ @ 0 J
Fig. 4.6.4.1
(d)
.SEARCH
DATA
data:
functional instruction S)
.DATA
TYPE
Select
data.
- 205 -
4. OPERATION
(e)
Displaying a symbol (F9 [SYMBOL]) This function eF9> displays the symbol or comment defined at a specified address. When
Address Symbol
Relay
Comment
1 1
Fig. 4.6.4.1
(e)
ADDRESS
: : : :
Enter
the
address
of
the
symbol
or
comment
to
be
displayed. SYMBOL The symbol at the specified address is appears. The relay comment The coil comment at the specified address appears. at the specified address appears.
RELAY COMMENT
. COIL COMMENT
(f)
. LADDER
MODE:
Switching editing
between
ladder
monitor
and
on-line
For details of the on-line edit function, see (2) line editing in this section.
On-
. SYMBOL
& COMMENT
DISPLAY:Selecting
the
address
display
mode
in ladder
symbol, and relay comment. FUNCTION PARAMETER: Selecting functional displayed When the < FlO > key is pressed, the dialog box shown below appears: key. To change the setting, press whether the parameters are to of be
instructions
To move the cursor to another item, press the <Tab> the < t > or < 1 > key.
- 206 -
4.
OPERATION
Dpisplay
- Ladder Mode @Ladder Monitor
satking
OOnline
Editor
-Symbol
6 Comment
Display
l Symbol
(1 Address 0 0 Relay Comment & Address & Address & Symbol Relay Comment (3 Symbol
(7 Relay Comment
-Ladder
(1 Ladder Monitor
-Symbol
& Comment
Display
l Symbol
0 Address (3 Relay Comment 0 Symbol 6 Address 6 Address 6 Symbol
Fig. 4.6.4.1
(g)
- 207 -
4. OPERATION
number
+ cF6>
_ine deletion
deletion
<Ctrl>
+ <Fi
nsertion
- 209 -
4.
OPERATION
On-line
editing
operations
(2)
ursor movemen
e cursor
up or
the cursor
to the left
<4->,
<+>
Symbol
Displaying the symbol or comment defined at a specified address Switching between ladder monitor and on-line editing, switching between symbol drsplay and comment display, etc. Updating the ladder program
F9 : (Symbol]
See (l),
Ladder monitor.
Setting
FlO : [Setting]
See (I),
Ladder monitor.
3thers
(i) 0 (i) @I
the input mode the input mode on the edit screen, Input mode is displayed at the use the following bottom mode right keys. of the screen. When
current
corner
nothing
is displayed,
it indicates
that overwrite
is selected
(default).
: : :
mode :
-c Insert Z
When inserted a contact or coil is entered posrtion. mode. in this mode, the contact or coil is at the cursor
Cancel
~8 Delete Key
-210-
4. OPERATION
Function
: :
function
Cancel
mode.
(d) Input Contact/Coil To input a contact <Enter > key. element is added to the ladder diagram. The following keys are used for or coil. register the input element in the key input line, then press the
Set +
Key Function
t: :
<Fl Set 4 > + k t_ at the input line. an address and
An addressed pressing
Set Key
---I
/ +
/ I--
the <Shift
Set Key
: :
<F2>
Set e
u key.
at the input line. is input to the key input line by entering an address and
the <F2>
Set
Key
+
: :
<Shift Set e e > + <F2> at the input line. is input to the key input line by entering > and CF2> keys. an address and
the <Shift
6) Set
Key
-(S)-
: :
G3 Set
Key
-(R)-
: :
the
-2ll-
4.
OPERATION
Contact/Coil
: :
+ <TAB> at the input line. Contact/Coil in the input reverse. in the order indicated below: line to the forward
direction.
< Shift > + -Z TAB > changes and coils are displayed
The contacts
address
only address Change + < Enter > address on ladder diagram without changing input line.
: :
The contact
position
is modified.
[Input @
Key
Function
c Enter > Write ContactCoil which is set at input line to ladder diagram.
(e) Connect/delete
line
Input - Key Function <F4> Input horizontal horizontal line. line. If In the delete mode, delete Contact/Coil or
I <F5> A vertical delete ltne IS entered to the right of the cursor position. In
mode,
a vertical
line is deleted.
(f)
Inserting
(1)
a net
: :
<Ctrl> inserts
+ Fl [Netlns] a single blank net after the net at the cursor position.
-212-
4. OPERATION
a lrne
: :
an element
: :
< Ctrl>
a range
: :
< Ctrl>
Specifies means i) ii)
+ F4 [Select] the range to be cut or copied. procedure: to the first net in the desired and < F4 > keys. range. .at the The range is specified by
Position
(SEL is displayed
right corner
iii)
Position Cutting
the cursor to the last net in the desired and copying of a specified net range
or @I below. Cancel
Press the < Ctrl > and < F4 > keys in range
mode.
a net
: :
<Ctrl>
+ F5 [Cut] When cut a net range portion is specified, in the the specified buffer for net range subsequent
is saved
a net
: :
<Ctrl> Copies
+ F6 [Copy] a net into the buffer for subsequent range pasting. When a net
range is specified,
the specified
is copied.
a net
: :
+ F7 [Paste] a net that was previously cut or copied and saved into the
-213-
4. OPERATION
: :
<T>,<l>
Up/Down press cursor, When press < 1 > at the top of the screen the screen scrolls. or < 4 > at the bottom of the screen,
r3
to Left/Right
: :
<c>
Move
, <+>
cursor to the left/light. the cursor < -+> When pressing moves < +> at the left end and right end.
the cursor
At the top.bottom
of the screen,
the screen
scrolls.
: :
-z Home >
Move cursor to the top of ladder
to the bottom
of ladder
: :
page
:
:
:
:
(i)
Others
6)
: :
Note)
function lhrs
program
function,
modification
-214-
4. OPERATION
: :
Note) 4.6.4.2
PMC
Applying
the [Undo]
function
causes
the effects
of editrng
to be lost.
Status
(1) Menu
position PMC Status window, pull down [2. Diagnose] menu, and select [PMC Status] on
. +
Signal Status PMC Parameters PMC alarm status RUN/STOP the ladder System Information
(2) Window
view
!iEkq ***/**
l
*a**/** PMC TYPE PMC-*'* SCAN1 CUR MAX NIN
Oms 7
-Series/Edition -Series/Edition
of PMC of ladder
Editing
Card
-Connected
PMC type
Current
-Month/Date/Year 7Hour:Minute:Second
Fig. 4.6.4.2
(a)
-215-
4. OPERATION
(1) Menu
position Signal Status window, pull down [2. Diagnose] menu, and select [signal Status]
\/ Ladder Monitor PMC Status Signal Statue PMC Parameters PMC alarm status RUN/STOP the ladder System Information
--f
(a) Window
view without
symbols
,. 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0
ROOOOO ROOOOl R00002 R00003 R00004 R00005 R00006 R00007 R00008 R00009
1 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0
0 0 1 0 0 0 1 0 0
Fig. 4.6.4.3
0 0 1 0 0 1 0 0 0
(a)
0 0 1 0 0 0 1 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0
: 55 : 00 : 00
-216-
4.
OPERATION
(b) Window
Cursor
t 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0
1
0 0 0
1
-OFF0 0 0 0 0
-ONf. 0 0 0 0
f' 0 0 0
PMC Address Byte symbol Fig. 4.6.4.3 (c) Function keys: (b)
Hexadecimal
expression
F4
Symbol or
F8 Search
FlO Wrt On or
(c)
Basic operation Cursor keys c Page up >: < Page down > <TAB >!< Shaft > + <TAB > Move cursor. Move address
Function
Skip to next/previous
c Enter >
Alternate signal status. <Enter > key turns the signal status ON whrch was OFF, and turns OFF which was ON. c Enter > key is effective only when the write-protection is unlocked. < F4 > Display/Hide Search symbols. (address can be symbol).
[ Symbol]:[Adress)
address
address
[Wrt On];[WrtOff]
Unlock write-protection/Re-protect. When the protection is effective the cursor is yellow, and becomes red when unlock.
-217-
4. OPERATION
(Warning)
status care.
changes Signal
should parameter
always
be made can
with have it
changes
and unforeseen
on a control used.
to which
It is recommended
functions
not be
(Note)
to change programs,
some
signal
statuses
may
fail.
At an external
address
to
which write to F
the CNC,
MMC,
to X addresses.)
(4) Message
and countermeasure
signal status although write-protected. If the answer [Yes]. Otherwise, answer [No] to
Keep relay window Data table control Data table window window
To display Parameter]
submenu,
display
pull-down
menu,
then select
[PMC
The submenu
can be displayed
by pressing
the
positioned
to
Tf@rl
.,
......
Counter
control
-218-
4. OPERATION
(Warning)
When
changing
a signal
status
or PMC parameter,
extreme
care
is necessary. incorrectly,
If
is applied
act unpredictably.
function
if personnel
are
present
(Note)
If you can not write PMC parameter, For the detail, please
it might
be protected. manual.
window window displays address, the contents of PMC Timer address. You can examine for TMR instruction. the contents
of PMC Timer
the values
(a) Menu posrtion To active the menu. window. Timer Then window, sub-menu pull down appears [2. Diagnose] which contains menu, item and select [Timer] [PMC Parameter] on
which
activates
Timer
12.
Diagnose
Ladder Monitor PMC Status Sicinal Status i*Timet: . PM; Eiara,,tert' PMC alarm status Counter RUN/STOP the ladder Keep relay System Information Data table control Data table
,. I
(b) Window 0
Window
symbols:
Ti er 1.
2. 3. 4.
:
TO0020 TO0022 TO0024 TO0026 TO0028 TO0030 TO0032 TO0034 TO0036 TO0038
(a)
.: . .. ,.: ,.:..,
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
TOO000
TO0002 TO0004
600000
0 0 0 0 0 0
11.
0 ~ 12.
5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10.
1000
0 120.
Fig. 4.6.4.4
-219-
4.
OPERATION
ker
: 0 0 0
*1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
600000 0 0 0 0
6. 7. 8. 9. 10.
F4 Symbol or F4 Adress 1---TFig. 4.6.4.4 (c) Operations The following table lists the operations supported (c)
F8 Search
ii
II
by the [TIMER]
window.
Function
area on window.
Change timer value. Enter new timer value in milli-seconds. You can enter new value only when the write-protection is unlocked. The valid timer values are : O-3,145.680 ms for timer No. l-8 o-523.280 ms for timer No. 9-150 Display/Hide symbols.
[SymbolJ/[Adress]
< F4 >
- 220 -
4.
OPERATION
Function Search address (address can be symbol). You cannot search any other address than PMC parameter address, T, C, K, and D. at the Timer window. When C, K or D address is specified to search, Timer window is closed and the special window for the address is opened with the address at top of window.
number
+ [Search]
ISearch
timer address
by timer number.
[Wrt On)/[WrtOff]
Unlock write-protectionIRe-protect. When the protection is effective the cursor IS yellow, and becomes red when unlocked.
(d) Message
Meaning
You tried to change timer value although If the attempt is intended, answer [Yes]. [No] to cancel change.
(2)
window window displays the contents of PMC Counter address. the values You can examine the
of PMC Counter
address,
(a) Menu posrtion To actrvate Counter Then window, sub-menu pull down appears 12. Diagnose] whrch menu, and select [Counter] [PMC Parameter] which activates
contains
item
window.
!.
Diagnose
P&K Parameteif
PMC alarm status RUN/STOP the ladder System Information
control
-221-
4.
OPERATION
Window
view without
symbols
,.,
..
.Y:
,.: ..
,.,.
., ....
.: :.
..
No.
Address cooooo coooo4 COO008 coo012 COO016 c00020 COO024 COO028 COO032 COO036
No. Address 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20.
(d)
Preset/Current
1.
2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
9. 10.
c00040 coo044 COO048 COO052 COO056 COO060 COO064 COO068 c00070 COO076
o/ o/ o/ o/ o/ o/
o/ o/
o/
o/
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Window
Cursor
n ;eic
No.
:;:
,:
2.
:.:: :_.::,_;
,:.:,;
::
..,
Preset/Current O/ O/ 36/ O/ O/ 0 0 0 0 0
pzY_, cooooo
347 129 0 0
6. 7. 8. 9. 10.
I
@I Functton
2. 3. 4. 5.
256/ O/ O/
J_
l
number
value value
(e)
keys :
F4 Symbol or
F8 Search
FIO Wrt On or
Fig. 4.6.4.4
(e)
-222-
4.
OPERATION
(c) Operations The table below lists the operations supported by the [COUNTER] window.
Function
Change timer value. You can enter new value write-protection is unlocked. The valid counter values are : O-65,535 for binary counter O-9,999 for BCD counter Display/Hide symbols.
Search address (address can be symbol). You cannot search any other address than PMC parameter address, T, C, K, and D, at the Counter window. When T, K or D address is specified to search, Counter window is closed and the special window for the address is opened with the address at top of window. Search counter address by timer number.
number
+ [Search]
< F8 >
[Wrt On][WrtOff]
Unlock write-protectionIRe-protect. When the protection is effective the cursor is yellow, and becomes red when unlocked.
(d) Message
Meaning
and countermeasure
You tried to change counter value although write-protected. If the attempt is intended, answer [Yes]. Otherwise, answer [No] to cancel change.
(3) Keep relay window Keep relay window displays the status of PMC Keep relay address. You can examine the
(4 Menu position
To activate Keep relay window, Then pull down (2. Diagnose] which contains menu, and select relay] (PMC which Parameter] activates on the menu. sub-menu appears item [Keep
Keep relay window. !. / Diagnose Ladder Monitor PMC Status Signal Status PMC Paramtrtojt PMC alarm status RUN/STOP the ladder System Information
-+
- 223 -
4.
OPERATION
(b) Window
view
~Address
c I.+
I
F
7 ,.,
Cursor Keep .: 1 Y.
0 0 @l&y :...:: .:I..
,.
KOOOOO KOOOOl K00002 K00003 K00004 KOO005 K00006 K00007 K00008 K00009
_IL
0
0 0 0 0
.. ..
:
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
.,.
,, .. ::
.:I,
.,
..i.,..
:..
.,.
,.
. ,j
0 0
0 0
0
0
1
0
KOOOlO KOOOll K00012 K00013 K00014 K00015 K00016 K00017 K00018 K00019
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0
0 0
0 0 0 0
0 0
0 0 0
0 0 0
0 0 0
0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0
0
0 0 0 0
0
0 0 0
0 0
0 0 0
0 0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
@I Function
Keys :
F8 Search
FlO Wrt On
(h)
Functron
< Page up > i < Page down > < Enter >
area on window.
Alternate slgnal status. <Enter> key turns the signal status ON which was OFF, and turns OFF which was ON. <Enter> key is effective only when the write-protection is unlocked. + [Search] < F8 > Search address (address can be symbol). You cannot search any other address than PMC parameter address, T, C, K, and D, at the Keep relay window. When T, C or D address is specified to search, Keep relay window is closed and the special window for the address is opened with the address at top of window. Unlock write-protection/Re-protect. When the protection is effective the cursor is yellow, and becomes red when unlocked.
address
[Wrt On]i[WrtOff]
< FlO>
- 224 -
4. OPERATION
(d) Message
and countermeasure
signal status although write-protected. If the answer [Yes]. Otherwise, answer [No] to
Some keep relay data are used by PMC control In this manual, the addresses related to the
described. For the detail, (The addresses PMC control please refer PMC programming I* do not effect manual. of the On-line function but used by
marked
the operation
software.)
#7
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
l
#l
#O
DTBLDSP
MEMINP
PRGRAM
LADMASK
#7 #4
0 0
#l #O
in I/O menu.
#7 *
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
l
#l *
#O FROM-WRT
#O
(4)
FROM-WRT
: Displaying
F-ROM
write dialog
On-line
editing.
on this window.
which activates
table control
-225-
4.
OPERATION
Ladder Monitor PMC Status Signal Status PMC alarm status RUN/STOP the ladder System Information Timer Counter Keep relay Dhta table control"~. ::' Data table
:
Cursor
D&ta
JO.
,. : ....... .:..: . .
Start address
f: f
I
Start address: symbol of the group Data group number Number
Data size
I
Write-protection
Fig. 4.6.4.4
(?,I Function
keys:
F4 Symbol
F8 Search
-226-
4. OPERATION
(c) Operations The table below lists the operations display (1). supported by the Data table control window. Table of
I__
Function
I Move cursor. I
Move address area on window
< Page up > i < Page down > D-address + c Enter >
Change Start address with the cursor on the item. You can enter new address only when the write-protection is unlocked. You can omit the leading character D of the address. Change Number with the cursor on the item. You can enter new number only when the write-protection is unlocked. Format and Protection with the cursor on Change Type, the item. When the cursor is on Type or Format, small dialog box is displayed to choose the item. You can change them only when the write-protection is unlocked.
number
display
(2).
Function Make new data group. [New] duplicates the data group on the cursor. A hundred data groups can be created at most.
[Delete]
c F2 >
Delete data group on the cursor. You cannot delete groups because one data group must exist at least. Switch to Data table was on is displayed. < F4 z= Display/Hide symbols. window. The data group
[G.Data]
< F3>
[ Symbol][ address
Adress]
Search address (address can be symbol). You cannot search any other address than PMC parameter address, T, C, K and D, at the Data table control window. When T, C, K or D address is specified to search, Data table control window is closed and the special window for the address is opened with the address at top of window. Search data group by data group number.
number
(Wrt On]/[WrtOtf]
Unlock write-protection/Re-protect. When the protection is effective the cursor is yellow, and becomes red when unlocked.
-227-
4. OPERATION
(d) Messages
Meaning
and countermeasure
You tried to change signal status although write-protected. If the attempt is intended, answer [Yes]. Otherwise, answer (No] to cancel change.
(5)
table table
window window displays the contents data. of PMC Data table address according to Data and
defined
the contents
of Data table,
(a)
Menu position To activate Data table window, pull down (2. Diagnose] which menu, item and [Data select table] [PMC which
Parameter] activates
Then sub-menu
appears
contains
window.
2. Diagnose
d
Ladder Monitor PMC Status Siqnal Status Timer PMC alarm status RUN/STOP the ladder System Information
Counter
Window
view without
symbols
:
Data table
..
protected
Group
1 : DO0000
- 007999, F6 FF EC FF D8 FF BO FF 60 FF
8000 bytes.
hexadecimal,
1
00 D8 00 BO 00 00 BO 00 00 00
DO0000 DO0001 DO0002 DO0003 DO0004 DO0005 DO0006 DO0007 DO0008 DO0009
co FE 80
FD 00
FB 00 F6 00 EC
DO0020 DO0021 DO0022 DO0023 DO0024 DO0025 DO0026 DO0027 DO0028 DO0029
- 228 -
4. OPERATION
Data group
information:
Group
1 : DOOOO- D07999,
t Area of Data group
8000 bytes,
rotected
Write-protection
Window
Data group
rnformation
-Data
table.
.,
~Groupl:DOOOOO
- D07999,
protected
FF BO FF 60 FF
co FE 80 FD 00
FF EC FF D8
(I)
F3 C.Data
F4 Symbol or
F8 Search
FlO Wrt On or
T-1
F4 Adress Ftg. 4.6.4.4 (m)
- 229 -
4. OPERATION
(c) Operations The following Operations table lists the operations supported by [DATA supported window by the [DATA TABLE1 window.
TABLE]
Basic operation Cursor keys -z Page up > J< Page down > <TAB s/c Shift > + c TAB > + < Enter > Move cursor. Move address
Function
Skip to next/previous
number
Change data value. You can enter new value only when the write-protection is unlocked. The valid data values are : For details of the values that can be input, see the table of input data values below. Switch to Data table control window. The displayed data group is displayed at top of the window.
(CData]
< F3 >
Dtsplay/Hide
symbols.
Search address (address can be symbol). You cannot search any other address than PMC parameter address, T, C, K and D, at the Data table window. When T, C or K address is specified to search, Data table window is closed and the special window for the address is opened with the address at top of window. Search data group by data group number.
number
+ [Search]
[Wrt On]/(WrtOff]
Unlock write-protectionGte-protect. When the protection is eflective the cursor is yellow, and becomes red when unlocked.
Data table
I
Decimal BCD
(dword)
- 2,147,483,647
99,999,999 FFFFFFFF
(d) Messages
Meaning
and countermeasure
You tned to change data table value although write-protected. If the attempt is intended, answer [Yes]. Otherwise, answer (No] to cancel change.
- 230 -
4.
OPERATION
4.6.4.5
The PMC
(1) Menu
position
PMC alarm message dialog box, pull down [2. Diagnose] menu, and select [PMC on the menu.
-_)
System
Information
(2) Window
ALARM NOTHING
Fig. 4.6.4.5
(a)
PMC
alarm message
dialog
box.
(4) Messages
The alarm messages See the manual For details FANUC NB/NB2 same as PMCs are displayed in this window. of PMC for detail of the messages. refer to the following manual:
MODEL
PAliPAB/RAlIRA2RA3/RBIRB2/RB3IRB4/RB5/RB6iRC/RC3/RC4~
Programming
Manual
(B-61 863E)
-231
4. OPERATION
4.6.4.6
The ladder
RUNNING.
(1) Displaying
To display
then select
2. Diagnose 4 Ladder Monitor PMC Status Signal Status -3 PMC Parameter PMC alarm status : ?.g?JNpJ*iiop..f& ::&$&&$f
System
Information
(2)
Displaying
(a) Ladder
running
While a ladder
Frg. 4.6.4.6
(a)
[YES] [NO]
- 232 -
4. OPERATION
(b) Ladder stop state While a ladder program is in the stop state, the following dialog box appears.
Fig. 4.6.4.6
(b)
[YES] [NO]
Executes
(Warning)
program is applied incorrectly, the machine may act unpredictably. Avoid using the function if personnel are present near the machine.
4.6.4.7
The system software information such as specifications, Menu position System Information on the menu. dialog
(1)
To display [System
12.
Dragnose]
menu,
and select
Information]
2. Diagnose Ladder Monitor PMC Status Signal Status + PMC Parameter PMC alarm status RUN/STOP the ladder System Xnformation
(2)
Displaying
dialog
When [System
lnformatton] is selected,
< Space > or <. > key to close System Information dialog box
System
Information
FAPT LADDER-II A08B-9201-J503 Version 01.2 96.01.09 Copyright(C) 1995. FANUC LTD
Frg. 4.6.4.7 (a)
- 233 -
4. OPERATION
4.6.5
Input/Output
provides the following options:
1. For the [LOAD FROM PMC] dialog box 2. For the [STORE IN PMC] dialog box 3. For the [WRITE F-ROM] dialog box
(Note 1)
In case
of operating
display
of NC (Position,
etc.)
might
slow
when
functions
(Load from PMC, Store to PMC, etc.). of NC. It is recommended to using input/output
is no problem
in the operation
functions
while NC is not operating. made by C language executor is displayed, the communication after moving speed to other
(Note 2)
When
screen
decreases. screens
It is recommended etc.).
to use
input/output
functions
(Posrtion,
4.651
A program LOAD when,
a ladder
function.
(1) Menu
position the LOAD FROM PMC dialog box, display the 13. l/O] pull-down menu, then
- 234 -
4. OPERATION
(2)
Displaying Selecting
LOad
.. .:,l:.:j.. from pMc . ,\ ....:,. ,. ,......./. .: .....&, .,.....( y,,::...:: ..::.. : ... .::.
- Transfer . 0% I j
data LADDER
..
_r^
Programs izeindicator
Abort loading Execute loading Close dialog Fig. 4.6.5.1 (a) box
(3) Operation Select a desired button by pressing the <Tab > key, then press the < Enter > key. normally, the dialog box closes automatically. Once the program has been loaded
4.6.5.2
A program Use Store
Storing
to the PMC
computer a ladder is transferred program to the PMC. from the personal computer to the PMC to
enable,
for example,
function.
Menu
position the Store to PMC dialog box, display the 13. l/O] pull-down menu, then select
To display [Store
-235-
4. OPERATION
(2) Displaying
Selecting
(Store
stag*
tQ
p#fc . ;.
: ,.
.::: .,:.: :: :
.,
,..I
:.j.
..
-Transfer
data
0 LADDER 0%
I
Execute storing
Aborl
storing
I
Close dialog Fig. 4.6.5.2 (a) box
(3) Operation
Select a desired button by pressing the <Tab > key, then press the c Enter > key.
Once the program has been stored normally, the dialog box closes automatically.
(Note)
While enable
Online storing
Edrtor
is in progress,
a program
cannot
be stored
to the
PMC.
To
to Ladder
Monitor. is stored will to the PMC but before be lost. 4.6.5.3). When storing the a
program
results
of editing
write it to F-ROM
(see Section
4.653
The results
Writing to F-ROM
of editrng by the on-ltne function are written to flash ROM (F-ROM) in the PMC.
(Note)
The results
of rnodificatron
made
using
Online
Editor,
Store
to PMC,
off before
the results
are written
to F-ROM.
To store
- 236 -
4. OPERATION
(1) Menu
select
position to Flash ROM dialog box, display the 13. I/O] pull-down menu, then
rri
(2)
Displaying
the dialog
Selecting [F-ROM
Write1 causes
.. . .c. ..
to write
to
IExec/ICancel]
I
Execute Fig. 4.6.5.3 (3) Operation (a)
box
Cg, Select
[Cancel]
or Press
box is closed.
(Note)
to Flash ROM.
-237-
4. OPERATION
4.6.6
Communication
or disconnects a communication link between a personal computer link is established and
between establish
the personal computer and PMC. the communication Selecting [ON-LINE link. FUNCTION]
or [ON-LINE
(SELECTED automatically.
PROGRAM)]
link to be established
(1)
Menu
(2) Displaying
the dialog
box
dialog box
Communication
communication
(b)
appear as shown below. Press the <Tab7 a cursor key. key to select the desired parameter, then set that parameter by pressing
-238-
4. OPERATION
Parity
l
-Stop 01
(3 Odd
(.) Even
2 bit
T-_rl
t Close dialog
I
be established connected (See Appendix
T
-
Parity bit
Stop bit
box canceling
modifications
(Note 1)
link cannot
successfully,
check
the following
cable
securely
to both
the personal
compuler
and
cable?
8.)
after these
(Note 2)
Do
not
attempt
Do not drsconnect
link.
the RS232C
cable
the communication
-239-
4.
OPERATION
4.6.7
Examples of operation
provides the followrng two examples of using the on-line function:
This section
Monitoring
a ladder program
Monitoring
a ladder program
held by a personal
computer
4.6.7.1
(1) Connecting
one
end
of the
RS232C
cable
to the
COMl
or
COM2
port
of the
personal
(b) Connect
the other
cable
to the R232-1
or R232-2
(2) Setting
the parameters
monitor
on the PMC
(a) Press
the
CNCs
[PMC],
[MONIT], MONITOR
and
[ONLINE] appears.
soft
keys
in
that
order.
The
PARAMETERS
FOR ONLINE
screen
parameters.
(See Section
4.6.2.
Preparation.)
USE
for the
RS232C
parameter.
Check
that
the
RS232C
status
Indication
to STAND-BY.
(Note)
If USE is specified
STAND-BY
status
is automatically
selected
when
is unnecessary.
(3) Starting
the on-line
function
the following
command:
(When FAPT-LADDER
under
C: y FLADDER)
- 240 -
4.
OPERATION
(b) The
title
01 FAPT below.
appears. menu
After contains
a few the
seconds, and
the edition
initial
menu
appears LADDER
series
of FAPT-
RBI(STEP SEQ)
[ C:YDFITRYSWLE 1
Version 01.0
RO8B-9201-5503
Press [TFIBI key to move the cursor and press [ENTER] or lSPRCE1 key to select Off-Line Function
I I
I
1
I I
I I
Exit
(a)
monitor
screen
appears
as shown
below.
Communication
Try to connect
with
PllC ___
08130 WOO
J/Cancel/I
F7 Spl ist
F8 Search
FY Synbol
FlO Seting
-241
4.
OPERATION
(Note)
If
communication
be
established,
select
the
[Param]
button
in
the
Communication subsequently
Check
appears.
:..
: :.i
;.,:
.::i..:.::.;
:..I..
w=mwter..
cot42
: :: ... . .:.::>
,,
is:::..
Channel 0 COMl 0
Stop 01
bit bit
2 bit
Fig. 4.6.7.1
(c)
(e) When
communication
starts
normally,
the
Communication
dialog
box
closes
automatically. PMC
Transfer .
data LADDER
type 0 ALL
Fig. 4.6.7.1
(d)
(Note)
monitored
program
is used,
required
continuously,
4.
OPERATION
(4) Selecting
a subprogram
a program below:
IS loaded
from
the PMC,
the Sub-program
list
dialog
box appears
as
subiprogram
. . / ., .:. .:
,ii,=t
.. ;
L&v&{1
,., .,., 2
.:...
<::.:
I::;.:
..). ,/,:,
2,.
.,..;
:I; ,:.
;,I:;: ;::;.
LEVEL 2 PO0001 (OPEN RIGHT DOOR ) PO0002 (OPEN LEFT DOOR ) PO0010 (GRIP WORK PEICE ) PO0011 (PUT WORK PIECE ) PO0021 (CLOSE RIGHT DOOR) PO0022 (CLOSE LEFT DOOR )
MOVE RIGHT DOOR TO LIMIT-SWTH-Rl MOVE LEFT DOOR TO LIMIT-SWTH-Ll PICK UP A WORK ON THE STAND PUT DOWN A WORK MOVE RIGHT DOOR TO LIMIT-SWTH-R2 MOVE LEFT DOOR TO LIMIT-SWTH-L2
Fig. 4.6.7.1
(e)
(b) By
pressing
the
< 7 >
or
< 1 >
key,
position
the
cursor
to the
subprogram
to
be
dlsplayed.
(c)
Press the
<Enter7
key.
diagram
subprogram
is displayed.
- 243 -
4.
OPERATION
action
of ladder window
Monitor
the Ladder
Monitor
1. File
2.Diagnose
3. I/O La&de*
. [LEVEL i] DO00 I
DO00
I . SUB END1 1
F8 Search
F9 Symbol
FlO Seting
(b)
and coil status are displayed to Indicate their status: ON (1) or OFF (0). They are
with thick or thin line according ON (1) -1 w --( q __ F )-(S)CR)_ k Thick Thin Thick Thick Thick Thick
to their status as follows. OFF (0) Thin Thick Thin Thin Thin Thin
destmation.
244 -
4.
OPERATION
(4
Searching
for a net position, number enter the number of the net to be displayed, key F8 [SEARCH]. its address, or
(e)
Openrng Pressing
setting
causes
settrng
dialog
box to appear.
biepfay
setting
- Ladder
(1) Ladder -Symbol .
Symbol
0 Address
0 Relay Comment c> Symbol b Address @Relay Comment & Address cj Relay Comment 6 Symbol
- Function 0 Display
Parameter
1
(g) and check box. Display. The Then, functional press the setting dialog instruction
Fig. 4.6.7.1
(f)
instruction to
parameters Parameter
Function the
to close
Display below:
appear
as shown
-OFF+
RST ACT
SUB 36 ADDB
0002 TCNT-1
TCTRL- 1 ---i t
121
0000000001
NXT-TCNT
I
u_ Conlents TCNT-1 of address 1
131
Fig. 4.6.7.1
(h)
- 245 -
4.
OPERATION
...
. . .\.
&
Fig. 4.6.7.1
(k)
(cl
Checking whether a program is running While a ladder program is running, the icon shown in Fig. 4.6.7.1 ladder program is running, the icon indicated icons, see (4), Displaying in Fig. 4.6.7.1 (I) is visible. When no
(m) is visible.
(For details of
Program on PMC
is running.
Fig. 4.6.7.1
(I)
Fig. 4.6.7.1
(m)
To change RUNiSTOP
the ladder
program
execution
status,
select
12.
Diagnose]
then
use the
(d)
with the PMC has not been established, (For details of icons, see (4). Displaying
in Fig. 4.6.7.1
iiiiz!l
Communication is active. /
Fig. 4.6.7.1 (n) When changing the status of the communication Communrcation] dialog box. being performed
Fig. 4.6.7.1
(0)
- 247 -
4. OPERATION
(7) Monitoring
signals
GO0000
0,.
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
GO0001
GO0002 GO0003 GO0004 GO0005 GO0006 GO0007 GO0008 600009
0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0
0 0
: :
00 00 : 00 : 00 00
0
0 0 0 i 0
0
0
:oo
:
0
0 0 0
:oo
: 00 : :
00 00
Fig. 4.6.7.1
(p)
F8 Search
FlO Wrt On or
(b)
Searching Address Enter RO.0 and press function key < F8 > (Search], the address ROOOOO is displayed at top
Status 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 : : : :
42
00 00 00
R00009
0
Fig. 4.6.7.1
0
(r)
: 00
- 248 -
4. OPERATION
(cl
Displaying Function
symbol key
displays defined
of addresses address
the their
are also
on the window.
are displayed,
the function
c F4 > changes
byte symbol
bit symbols
:.. ,,.
. . . 0 0
signal
SPatus
.: y ,.. :I., _)
0 0
0 0
0 0
I -ON1 0
-OFF0' 0
: 42 : 00
IR00004
:oo
(d)
Unlocking
write-protection key < FlO> [Wrt On] to unlock The color of cursor write changes protection of the contents yellow. of addresses
on the window.
to red from
to [WrtOff].
(Warning)
status
changes
should
always
be made
with
extreme
care. system,
Signal
status
serious it applies,
results
on a control used.
are improperly
It is recommended
functions
- 249 -
4.
OPERATION
status in the window to change, a signal by the cursor press keys, <Page key up> and the <Page signal down> status to the change.
then status
<Enter>
to make
key turns
ON which
status
OFF which
Stat&s
0 0
L 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
-ONL 1
-OFF0 0
: 42 : 02
R00004
0
Fig. 4.6.7.1
0
(t)
: 00
(Note)
Some diagram
signals writes
if you change
them,
because
the Ladder
frequently,
or the signals
updated
NC writes
on F-address,
on X-address.
(f)
Enabling Press
again [WrtOff) The color to re-protect of cursor the returns contents to yellow of addresses from red. on the window And the function
function
changes.
returns
to [Wrt On).
(9)
Status
wrndow menu, select [Ladder Monitor] from the menu, then the Signal
window
(Note)
Non-volatrle window
PMC address
T, C, K and D which
is called
PMC
parameter
has special
to display
and modify
-250-
4.
OPERATION
(8)
Storing
to flash
memory function is written to flash memory the results of the PMC. of editing If the CNC
A program is turned
is written
to flash memory,
will be lost.
the Write
dialog Select
Flash ROM
as shown
Select
program.
(The Executing
appears.
.,
Are
:.
you
Flash ROM ?
Fig. 4.6.7.1
(u)
the dialog
box closes
automatically.
(9) Storing
program
a program edited
to a file using the on-line function can be named and stored to a file. The stored
A program
can be decompiled
and edited
function.
to a file bar. Select Then, select [File save]. The Save program. program dialog
save
program
Program
name
YFLADDERYSAMPLE piq
Fig. 4.6.7.1 (v) After the file has been stored. the Save program dialog box closes automatically
(Note)
When named
a program PMC-RAM
or edited,
is
To store
is automatically
is monrtored
or
-251
4. OPERATION
II
Are
you
sure
you
want
to
exit
4.6.7.2
(1) Selecting
used.
a program
from the initial menu. Then, enter the name of the program to be
RBd(STEP SEQI
[ C:YDFITRYSRlVLEI
Werslon 01.0
ROBB-YZOl-J503
Press [TABI key to move the cursor and press [ENTERI or [SPFICEI key to select.
I I
ut I I Itu
Exit
I
I
Fig. 4.6.7.2
(a)
-252-
4.
OPERATION
(2) Starting
ISource
Memory
program
has
been
updated.
Compile
it
(Y/N)
card
format
file
has
been
updated.
Decompile
it?(Y/N)
or decompile
the program.
to the PMC is started, program subprogram the personal with screen computer is automatically held on the If not, connected to the
monitor
is compared selection
a program
PMC.
is displayed.
a dialog
below:
N:E-3160
Selected
program
is
not
same.
71
Load
from
PMC program
memory.
[Stole/
Store
to
PMC program
memory.
-1
Select
program.
IDisregard]
Disregard
difference.
Quit
On-Line
function.
Fig. 4.6.7.2
(b)
In this case,
select
[STORE]
to transfer
the selected
program
to the PMC.
(Note)
The
dialog
box does
above
appears
when
the
program
selected either
on
the
personal
program
is modified
monitor above
not appear.
the subprogram
selection
screen
The
ladder
monitor a ladder
and
signal
monitor
can
be
operated
as described
in Section
4.6.7.2,
Monitoring
program
on the PMC.
- 253 -
L
LL (1) Function name
Category (error, warning, etc.) Name of the processing which caused the error
The processing causing the error is represented by a single alphabetic character. Function name A 6 C D E F G H I J K L N Processing Initial menu and option setting Title editing I/O module editing System parameter editing Ladder diagram/step diagram editing Symbol and comment editing Message editing Printing Compilation Decompilation Mnemonic conversion Input/Output On-line monitor
(2) Message
Output messages are classified into the following categories. by single alphabetic characters.
F: Fatal error. The error number is 2xxx. The system can be operated, but processing of the user program cannot be continued because of an error. E: Error. The error number is Sxxx. Processing is continued, but the results will be lost. Alternatively, the processing is stopped.
W: Warning. The error number is 4xxx. Processing is continued. The results will be retained, but cannot be guaranteed.
-254-
5.1 A : INITIAL MENU (program name selection, option setting, Oh-Line execution)
5.1 .l Number A:F-2000 A:F-2001 A:F-2004 Fatal error Messsge INSUFFICIENT MEMORY. Contents
A: F-2005
The source program contains an invalid file or does not contain necessary files. Check the source program files.
Contents The name of the source program has not been input. Input the source program name.
The specified source program is not compatible with the system. For details of which machine models are compatible, see Section 1.2.2. Some system files (xxxx.TBL) cannot be found. Reinstall the system. The specified source program cannot be created because a directory having the same name already exists. Input another source program name. The specified path does not exist. Check the input source program name. A FORMAT-A/B program was specified when copying a source program. FORMAT-A/B cannot be used with FAPT LADDER-II. Convert the program via a memory card or mnemonic format file. For details, see Appendix 3. File xxxx cannot be read.
I
A:E-3124
CANNOT CREATE NEW PROGRAM XXXX. ILLEGAL PATH OF SOURCE PROGRAM NAME. SOURCE PROGRAM TYPE DIFFERENT.
A:E-3125 A:E-3126
XXXX FILE READ ERROR XXXX FILE READ ERROR. HIT ANL KEY.
1
File xxxx cannot be read. File xxxx cannot be opened. File xxxx cannot be closed. The file cannot be output because there is insufficient free space on the disk. Terminate the system and delete any unnecessary files in the disk to create more free space. The option file (OPTION) has been initialized because Its data was destroyed. File xxxx cannot be created.
XXXX FILE OPEN ERROR. XXXX FILE CLOSE ERROR INSUFFICIENT DISK ERROR.
A:E-3134 A:E-3137
INVALID OPTION INITIALIZED. (XXXX FILE WAS UPDATED.) CANNOT CREATE FILE XXXX.
-25!3-
Number A:E-3138
I
Contents
lLL;ANLXMyX
SOURCE PRO-
1NOT FOUND FILE. 1CANNOT OPEN FILE. 1CANNOT CLOSE FILE. 1FILE I/O ERROR.
t XXXX FILE I/O ERROR. UNKNOWN PMC SERIES. XXXX FILE WRITE ERROR. HIT ANY KEY.
I 1File xxxx cannot be opened. I File xxxx cannot be closed. ( An error occurred during file access. I
I I
5.2
5.2.1 Number B:E-3020 B:E-3021 BE-3022
B : TITLE EDITING
Error Message
FILE READ ERROR. HIT ANY KEY FILE WRITE ERROR. HIT ANY KEY FILE l/O ERROR. HIT ANY KEY Contemts The source program title file (TITLE) cannot be read. Datacannot be writtento the source programtitlefile (TITLE) or control file (CONTROL). An error occurred during file access.
INPUT KEY NOT USED ADDRESS APPOINT ILLEGAL The specified module cannot be used at this address. Check whether the output module is specified at address X and whether the input module is specified at address Y. The specified group, base, and slot have already been assigned modules. Specify different group, base, and slot numbers. The specified channel does not exist. Press F3 [HELP] to confirm which channels can be specified. For I/O Unit-B (xxx:power-on/off information), a slot other than slot 0 cannot be specified. Specify slot 0.
C: E-3032
THE SAME GROUP,BASE AND SLOT ARE ALREADY SPECIFIED. INVALID CHANNEL NO. APPOINT INVALID DATA, EXCEPT O, IS SPECIFIED AT THE SLOT OF XXX AS l/O UNIT B. Warning Message THE SAME GROUP,BASE AND SLOT ARE ALREADY SPECIFIED. INVALID DATA, EXCEPT O, IS SPECIFIED AT THE BASE OF I/O UNIT B. BOTH I/O UNIT-A AND UNIT-B ARE SPECIFIED IN THE SAME GROUP.
C: E-3033 C: E-3034
Contents The specified group, base, and slot have already been assigned modules. Check whether the same numbers can be assigned for the group, base, and slot. For the I/O Unit-B module, a base other than base 0 cannot be specified. Specify base 0. I/O Unit-A and I/O Unit-B cannot be assigned to the same group. Specify different groups.
C:W4021
C:W4022
-257-
-8SZ-
03 W
ss3tmv 39vw1 ma a31 (01 ssmaav 35ww1 lla A~U (6 ssmaav a31 (8 ss3k4aav ~3n (L :sseJppe t%y~o(lol eql Aweds (800~ JO pesn s! (wed JO)eMdO swwds W!W) 13NVd kiOlVU3dO (9
JW~W u! Es S! (S3A) 1 uWM ss3Haav
3niv~ (lOHlN03) aI!4lJW~ JO (VuVklVdSAS) al!l JW -weJed ureisk uJeJ6oJd 03Jnose~ioiue~yM eq iouum eiea (VuvtrvdsAs) w JwmJ~ .peeJ eq louue~ uwsAs UeJEbJd a3Jnos wi ~3y ANV 11~ ~Olj~3 A~W ANV IIH wow3 ebsse~
31l~M av3ti
muwJo3
9Nllla3
td313WWWd
InHlSAS
ps
1sn39vss3vu
klow3
Fatal error
Message CANNOT READ * FILE. CANNOT WRITE * FILE. CANNOT SEEK * FILE. Contents
5.5.2 Number
E:E-3100 E:E-3101 E:E3102 E:E-3103 E:E-3104 E:E-3105 E:E-3106 E:E-3107 E:E-3108 E:E-3109 E:E-3110 E:E-3111 E:E3112 E:E-3113 E:E-3114 E:E-3115 E:E-3116 E:E-3117 E:E-3118
I
1ADDRESS BIT NOTHING 1RELAY OR COIL NOTHING 1HORIZONTAL LINE ILLEGAL 1VERTICAL LINE ILLEGAL 1ILLEGAL FUNCTION NO.
FUNCTION LINE ILLEGAL PARAMETER NOTHING LADDER ILLEGAL ERROR NET FOUND RELAY OR COIL FORBIT
I I I I I
I
A Format-B program was found to exist when renaming a Format-A program. An invalid subprogram name was input.
THE ZOOM NESTING CONDITION WILL BE CANCELLED, IF YOU SELECT TO ZOOM I********. SOURCE PROGRAM OF ANOTHER FORMAT EXISTS A Format-B program, having the same name as that specified for the Copy/Move to file function, was found to exist during Format-A program editing.
E:E-3127
Number
E:E-3128 E:E-3129 E:E-3130 E:E-3131 E:E-3132
Messacle ILLEGAL SYMBOL PROGRAM OPEN ERROR PROGRAM NOT EXIST NOT EXIST APPOINT DATA SIZE PROGRAM NOT READ
Contents
A value that cannot be used as a symbol was input during symbol editing.
5.53 Number
E:E3200 E:E-3201 E: E-3202 E:E3203 E:E-3204 E:E-3205 E:E-3206 E:E-3207 E:E-3208
Contents
A read error occurred when reading the specified intermediate code file. An intermediate code exceeds the Edit buffer size. The maximum allowable number of branch nests has been exceeded. The maximum allowable number of branches has been exceeded. The maximum allowable numberof element tables has been exceeded. The step, transition, branch, or line is not continuous. The start sideof the select branch does not agree with its end side. The start side of the parallel branch does not agree with its end side. The sequence In the select branch is other than transition to step to transition. Or, the sequence in the parallel branch is other than step to transition to step. The step line contains an element other than initial step, step, block step, jump (dummy step), and serial move (vertical line). The transition line contains an element other than initial step, step, block step, and jump (dummy step). Insertion is not possible at the specified location. Or, if inserted, the maximum coordinate value is exceeded. A soft key that cannot be changed was specified when changing an element. A horizontal line was specified in place of the closing code of the branch. The label pointed to by JUMP does not exist. The intermediate code cannot be created because it has not been completely checked.
BIG.
NUMBER OF BRANCH TOO BIG. SIZE OF TABLE BUFFER TOO BIG. UNCONNECTED STEP SEQUENCE DIAGRAM. SELECTED BRANCH ERROR. PARALLEL BRANCH ERROR. SYNTAX ERROR.
E:E-3209
TRANSITION LINE SYNTAX ERROR. CANNOT INSERT. CANNOT MAKE DIAGRAM. HORIZONTAL LINE ILLEGAL. JUMP FORWARD CHECK ERROR. CHECK INCOMPLETE ERROR.
-260-
Number E:E-3216 1 E:E-3217 E:E-3218 E:E-3219 t--E:E-3220 E:E-3221 E: E-3222 E:E-3223 FEE3224 1 E:E-3225 1 E:E3226
Contents The step line is not properly connected to the transition line.
1The move destination is invalid. 1The specified coordinate value does not exist. I The specified character string does not exist.
I I
I I
E:E-3227 E:E-3228
The specified step number is already in use. Check which step numbers are already in use. I The specified label is already defined.
I
The temporary file cannot be deleted. The same file already exists, but with a different extension. Data outside the address range is set. No subprogram number is specified. An attempt was made to perform ZOOM for more than eight layers. I
TOO DEEP NESTING OF SUE PROGRAM. ILLEGAL FILE NAME. SUB-PROGRAM ALREADY
-261-
55.4
WILL BE CANCELLED, IF YOU SELECT TO SAVE. E:W4109 THE ZOOM NESTING CONDITION WILL BE CANCELLEDJF YOU SELECT TO UPDATE/APPEND. THE ZOOM NESTING CONDITION WILL BE CANCELLED, IF YOU SELECT TO OVERWRITE. MACHINE KIND AND INPUT PROGRAM NOT CONSISTENCY ! .
E:W4110
E:W4111
-262-
5.6
5.6.1 Error Number F:E-3100 F:E-3101 F:E-3102 F:E-3103 F:E-3104 F:E-3105 F:E-3106 F:E-3107 F:E-3108 F:E-3109 F:E-3110 1 Message INPUT DATA ILLEGAL. SYMBOL/COMMENT DATA TOO LARGE SAME SYMBO LDATA EXIST NO DEFINITION ADDRESS APPOINTED NOT FOUND DATA ERROR FILE READ ERROR HIT ANY KEY 1FILE WRITE ERROR HIT ANY KEY 1 1DATA SAVE ERROR 1SAME ADDRESS DATA EXISTS. t INPUT ADDRESS DATA. 1ILLEGAL SYMBOL. I 1 I I Contents
-263-
5.8 H : PRINTOUT
58.1 Number
H:F-2005 H:F-2066
Contents
FILE(S). ($)
CANNOT OPEN XXXX FILE. I
5.8.2 Number
H:E-3100
Error 1 I Message
INSUFFICIENT MEMORY. 1CANNOT OPEN XXXX FILE. 1CANNOT READ XXXX FILE.
Contents
An attempt was made to reserve memory, but there was insuffffient free space. File xxxx cannot be opened. File xxxx cannot be read. File xxxx cannot be found. File xxxx does not exist. The format of file xxxx is invalid.
H:E-3101 H:E-3102
1CANNOT WRITE XXXX FILE. 1OUTPUT FILE NOT DEFINED. WRITE ERROR OUTPUT FILE. INSUFFICIENT DISK SPACE NEED XXXX BYTE FREE
1
Data cannot be written to the file xxxx. An error occurred upon opening the output file. An error occurred upon writing to the output file. There is insufficient free space on the disk. Reserve xxxx bytes of free space. There is insufficient free space on the disk to pertom crossreference. Reserve xxxx bytes of free space. The maximum allowable number of steps for the ladder diagram has been exceeded. The maximum number of steps that can be printed is 32767. An error occurred upon reading symbol data. An error occurred upon reading a net comment. The symbol data is invalid.
H:E-3110
INSUFFICIENT CURRENT & TMP DISK SPACE NEED XXXX BYTE 1FREE STEP NUMBER (XXXX) OVER.
H:E-3111
H:E-3114
5.8.3 Number
H:W-tlOO H:WAlOl H:W-4102
Warning Message
CANCEL PRINTER OUTPUT. CANCEL FILE OUTPUT. SEL SWITCH OFF
Contents
The <BREAK> key was pressed before the completion of printing. The <BREAK, key was pressed during file output.
The SEL indicator on the printer is not lit. Press the SEL button such that the indicator lights.
-264-
5.9
5.9.1
Number I:F-2100 I:F-2101 5.9.2 Number I:E-3100 I:E-3101 I:E-3102 I:E-3103 I:E-3105 I:E-3107 I:E-3108 I:E-3109 I:E-3110 I:E-3111
I : COMPILE
Fatal error 1 Message I
Contents
Contents The source program cannot be read. (This error normally does not occur during compilation.) The compilation results cannot be written. An invalid source program name is specified. normally does not occur during compilation.) Source program xxxx does not exist. does not occur during compilation.) (This error
The source program format is FORMAT-A. mally does not occur during compilation.)
The source file for the system parameter data does not exist. The source file for the title data does not exist. The source file for the I/O module data does not exist. The input password differs from the registered password. Input the password correctly.
I:E-3112
charac-
I:E-3200 I:E-3201
An instruction that cannot be run by the specified program exists. A functional instruction is lacking a required coil.
I: E-3220
l:E-3221
The parameter of the subprogram start instruction (SP) contains a program number that does not correspond to the program name. An out-of-range program number or an address other than a program number is specified in a parameter of instruction xxxx. An out-of-range label number or an address other than a label number is specified in a parameter of instruction xxxx. The ladder program is empty. instruction. Specify the END1 or END2
I:E-3222
I: E-3223
The size of the ladder program exceeds the maximum size specified for the selected program type. An unrecognizable instruction exists.
Because the first level of the main program takes too long to execute, the ladder cannot be executed. Make the first level smaller, or increase the ratio of the ladder execution time in the system parameter.
-265-
Number I:E-3254
Contents Because the number of second level divisions in the main program exceeds the maximum of 99, the ladder cannot be executed. Make the second level smaller, or increase the ratio of the ladder execution time in the system parameter. SP is the start instruction for a subprogram. It cannot be used in the main program. SPE is the end instruction for a subprogram. It cannot be used in the main program. The JMPC instruction performs a jump from a subprogram to the second level of the main program. It cannot be used in the main program. The CALL instruction cannot be used because a subprogram cannot be called from other than the second level of the main program. The CALLU instruction cannot be used because a subprogram cannot be called from other than the second level of the main program. A subprogram must start with the SP instruction to indicate the start of the subprogram. A subprogram must end with the SPE instructiontojndicate the end of the subprogram. No instructions can be placed after the SPE instruction because the SPE instruction indicates the end of a subprogram. The SP instruction cannot be placed within a subprogram because the SP instruction indicates the start of a subprogram. The END1 instructionis not found at the end of the first level. The END2 instruction is not found at the end of the second level. The END3 instructionis not found at the end of the third level. No instructions can be placed after the END1 instruction because the END1 instruction indicates the end of the first level. No instructions can be placed after the END2 instruction because the END2 instruction indicates the end of the second level. No instructions can be placed after the END3 instruction because the END3 instruction indicates the end of the third level. No instructions can be placed after the END instruction because the END instruction indicates the end of the entire ladder program. END1 is specified for other than the first level. END2 is specified for other than the second level. END3 is specified for other than the third level. The END instruction is specified for the first level. The COME instruction is not specified when the COM instruction, that indicates the start of the instruction control range, is specified.
SP INSTRUCTION CAN NOT BE USED IN THE MAIN PROGRAM. SPE INSTRUCTION CAN NOT BE USED IN THE MAIN PROGRAM. JMPC INSTRUCTION CAN NOT BE USED IN THE MAIN PROGRAM. CALL INSTRUCTION CAN NOT BE USED EXCLUDING THE 2ND LEVEL MAIN PROGRAM. CALLU INSTRUCTION CAN NOT BE USED EXCLUDING THE 2ND LEVEL MAIN PROGRAM. THERE IS NO SP INSTRUCTtON AT THE TOP OF THE SUBPROGRAM. THERE IS NO SPE INSTRUCTION AT THE BOTTOM OF THE SUBPROGRAM. LADDER PROGRAM EXISTS BEYOND SPE INSTRUCTION. SP INSTRUCTION IS DETECTED IN THE SUBPROGRAM. THERE IS NO END1 INSTRUCTION. THERE IS NO END2 INSTRUCTlON. THERE IS NO END3 INSTRUCTION. LADDER PROGRAM EXISTS BEYOND END1 INSTRUCTION. LADDER PROGRAM EXISTS BEYOND END2 INSTRUCTION. LADDER PROGRAM EXISTS BEYOND END3 INSTRUCTION. LADDER PROGRAM EXISTS BEYOND END INSTRUCTION. END1 INSTRUCTION CAN NOT BE USED. END2 INSTRUCTION CAN NOT BE USED. END3 INSTRUCTION USED. CAN NOT BE
l:E-3273
I:E-3274
l:E-3290 l:E-3291
l:E-3292
l:E-3293
I:E-3314
I:E-3315
I:E-3316
Number l:E-3331
Message CALL INSTRUCTION CAN NOT BE USED IN THE RANGE CONTROLED COM INSTRUCTION. CALLU INSTRUCTION CAN NOT BE USED IN THE RANGE CONTROLED COM INSTRUCTION. ANOTHER COM INSTRUCTION CAN NOT BE USED IN THE RANGE CONTROLED COM INSTRUCTION. COME INSTRUCTION MUST BE THE PAIR WITH COM. COME INSTRUCTION IS DETECTED THOUGH THE CASE OF THE COIL NUMBER SPECIFICATION. THERE IS NO JMPE INSTRUCTION.
Contents The CALL instruction cannot be used because a subprogram cannot be called from within the COM instruction control range. The CALLU instruction cannot be used because a subprogram cannot be called from within the COM instruction control range. The COM instruction. that indicates the start of the instruction control range, is specified twice within the range.
l:E-3332
l:E-3333
l:E-3334
The COME instruction, that indicates the end of the instruction control range, is specified when the COM instruction, used to indicate the start of the range, is not specified. The COME instruction is specified to indicate the end of the instruction control range when the end of the range has already been defined as a number of coils. The JMP instruction is specified to indicate the start of the jump block, but the JMPE instruction, that indicates the end of the block, is not specified. Another JMP instruction is specified to indicate the start of a jump block before the JMPE instruction is specified to indicate the end of the first block. A JMPE instruction that indicates the end of a jump block is specified when no JMP instruction,that indicates the start of a block, is specified. A JMPE instruction is specified to indicate the end of a jump block when the end of the block has already been defined as a number of coils. The JMPB instruction does not contain label xxxx that indicates the jump destination. Two or more identical label numbers are found when defining jump destinations with the LBL instruction. Specify unique label numbers. The number of jump destinations defined with the LBL instruction exceeds the maximum allowable number that can be specified for the selected program type. Decrease the number of defined jump destinations. The JMPB instruction cannot be used to jump from a point inside to a point outside the COM instruction control range, or vice versa. JUMP operations can be performed only entirely within the range or entirely outside the range. The step sequence program contains a failed instruction or an instructionthat cannot be used with the selected program type. The parameter of the program stat-linstruction (SP) contains a program number that does not correspond to the program name. Instruction xxxx contains an out-of-range step number or an address other than a step number. Instruction xxxx contains an out-of-range program number or an address other than a program number. Instruction xxxx contains an out-of-range label number or an address other than a label number.
I:E-3335
l:E-3340
l:E-3341
ANOTHER JMP INSTRUCTION CAN NOT BE USED IN THE RANGE OF JMP INSTRUCTION. JMPE INSTRUCTION MUST BE THE PAIR WITH JMP. JMPE INSTRUCTtON IS DEIECTED THOUGH THE CASE OF THE COIL NUMBER SPECIFICATION. THERE IS NO LABEL OF XXXX. THE LABEL OF XXXX IS USED TWICE OR MORE. TOO MANY LABELS.
I:E-3342
l:E-3343
l:E-3350 l:E-3351
I:E-3352
l:E-3353
THE DESTINATION OF JMPB INSTRUCTION IS BEYOND COM/ COME INSTRUCTION. THERE IS AN UNDEFINED INSTRUCTION. PROGRAM NUMBER IS DIFFERENT FROM PROGRAM NAME. AN ILLEGAL STEP NUMBER IS SPECIFIED FOR THE XXXX INSTRUCTION. AN ILLEGAL PROGRAM NUMBER IS SPECIFIED FOR THE XXXX INSTRUCTION. AN ILLEGAL LABEL NUMBER IS SPECIFED FOR THE XXXX INSTRUCTION.
I:E-3400
I:E-3420
l:E-3421
l:E-3422
l:E-3423
-267-
Number LE-3440
Message THERE IS NO SP INSTRUCTION AT THE TOP OF THE SUBPROGRAM. THERE IS NO SPE INSTRUCTION AT THE BOTTOM OF THE SUBPROGRAM. STEP SEQUENCE PROGRAM EXISTS BEYOND SPE INSTRUCTION. SP INSTRUCTION IS DETECTED IN THE SUBPROGRAM. THE LABEL OF XXXX IS ASSIGNED FOR TWO OR MORE STEP PROGRAMS. TOO MANY LABELS.
Contents A subprogram must start with the SP instruction to indicate the start of the subprogram. A subprogram must end with the SPE instruction to indicate the end of the subprogram. No other instructions can be placed after the SPE instruction because the SPE instruction indicates the end of a subprogram. The SP instruction cannot be placed within a subprogram because the SP instruction indkates the startof a subprogram. Two or more defined jump destinations have identical label numbers. Define a unique label number for each jump destination. The number of defined jump destinations exceeds the number allowed for step sequence editing. Reduce the number of jump destination definitions. There is no label corresponding to the specified DSTEP instruction. Two or more steps have identical step numbers. Define a unique step number for each step.
l:E-3441
l:E-3442
l:E-3443 l:E-3460
l:E-3461
l:E-3462 l:E-3480
DSTEP INSTRUCTION WITHOUT DLBL. THE STEP NUMBER OF XXXX IS ASSIGNED FOR TWO OR MORE STEP PROGRAMS.
l:E-3570
THE SIZE OF THE MESSAGE DATA The amount of message data exceeds the maximum numIS TOO LARGE. ber of characters that can be specified for the selected program type. Reduce the total number of characters. DATA TOO LARGE. (LADDER + STEP SEQUENCE) The combined size of the ladder program and the step sequence program exceeds the maximum allowable size specified for the selected program type. Reduce the size of the ladder or step sequence program. The combined size of the message, symbol, comment, ladder, and step sequence data exceeds the maximum allowable size specified for the selectecl program type. Reduce the size of any of these data types. The selected program does not contain any subprogram fife numbered xxxx. Create a subprogramfile having this number. The END instruction is placed at the end of the second level when it is followed by a subprogram. Or, the END instruction is placed at the end of a subprogram when there is a subsequent subprogram having a higher program number. There is no label corresponding to the specified JMPC instruction. In the main program, two or more LBL instruction jump destinations have identical label numbers. Define a unique label number for each jump destination. The total number of LBL instruction jump destinations defined in the main program exceeds the maximum allowable number specified for the selected program type. Reduce the total number of jump destinations defined in the main program. Label xxxx, indicating a jump destination, cannot be placed in other than the second level because the JMPC instruction specifies a jump from a subprogram to the second level of the main program. Define label xxxx in the second level. Label xxxx, indicating the jump destination of the JMPC instruction, is within the COM instruction control range. Place label xxxx outside the range.
I:E-3600
I:E-3601
DATA TOO LARGE. (MESSAGE + SYMBOL + COMMENT + LADDER + STEP SEQUENCE) THERE IS NO SUBPROGRAM xxxx. LADDER/STEP SEQUENCE PROGRAM EXISTS BEYOND END INSTRUCTION. THERE IS NO LABEL OF XXXX. THE LABEL OF XXXX IS USED TWICE OR MORE. TOO MANY LABELS.
l:E-3620 l:E-3640
l:E-3650 l:E-3651
l:E-3652
l:E-3653
l:E-3654
-268-
Warning Message THE TITLE DATA WHICH COULD NOT BE DISPLAY ON THE CNC WAS REPLACE WITH SPACE CODE. ILLEGAL OPPANEL (PARAMETER). PROCEED TO COMPILE USING NO EDITING SUEPROGRAM NOT COMPLETED. HAS WITH Contents The title data contains kana or kanji characters. These characters are replaced by spaces.
I:W4101
Necessary addresses (key address, LED address, etc.) are not set when YES is specified for the system parameter indieating whether the FO operator panel is to be used. The value of this parameter is changed to NO during compilation. There is a subprogram for which editing has not yet been completed. Complete the editing of this subprogram. Twosubprograms haveidenticalnumbers(e.g., Pl.#lAand Pl.#SS). The ladder program is the first to be compiled (Pl.#tA in the above example). Symbols and comments are always output in FORMAT-B.
I:W4102 I:W4103
I:W4104
THE SOURCE-PROGRAM IS FORMAT-B. THIS PARAMETER IS IGNORED:SYMBOL/COMMENT THE SOURCE-PROGRAM IS FORMAT-B. THIS PARAMETER IS IGNORED: NET COMMENT THERE IS NO LADDER PROGRAM. LADDER EXECUTION TIME AT THE 1ST LEVEL IS TOO LARGE. THE COIL NUMBER SPECIFICATION OF COM INSTRUCTION IS NOT ALLOWED. THE COIL NUMBER SPECIFICATION OF JMP INSTRUCTION IS NOT ALLOWED. UNUSED NET COMMENT POINTER FOUND. THERE IS NO STEP SEQUENCE PROGRAM. THE SYMBOL DATA WHICH COULD NOT BE DISPLAY ON THE CNC WAS REPLACED WITH SPACE CODE. THE COMMENT DATA WHICH COULD NOT BE DISPLAY ON THE CNC WAS REPLACED WITH SPACE CODE. COMMENT DATA SIZE EXCEEDS 64KB. SYMBOUCOMMENT DATA IS NOT CONVERTED TO THE MEMORY CARD FORMAT FILE. THE MESSAGE DATA WHICH COULD NOT BE DISPLAY ON THE CNC WAS REPLACED WITH SPACE CODE. UNREFERENCED xxxx. SUBPROGRAM
I:W4105
The FORMAT-B data does not include a net comment. Specifying this item has no effect. The ladderprogram isempty. Thisladderprogramisnotoutput to a memory card file. The first level of the main program takes too long to execute. Make the first level smaller, or increase the ratio of the ladder execution time in the system parameter. The end of the COM instruction control range cannot be specified as a number of coils. The specified number of coils is ignored, the end of the range being identified by the COME instruction. The end location of a jump cannot be specified as a number of coils. The specified number of coils is ignored, the end location being identified by the JMPE instruction. The ladder program contains a pointer to a lost net comment character string. This pointer is not ouiqut to a memory card file. The step sequence program is empty. This step sequence program is not output to a memory card file. The symbol data contains a special character that cannot be handled by the CNC. This character is replaced by a space.
I:W4200 I:W4201
l:W4202
l:W4203
I:W4501
The comment data contains a special character that cannot be handled by the CNC. This character is replaced by a space. More than 65,535 characters have been input as comment data. None of the symbol and comment data is output to a memory card file. The message data contains a special character that cannot be handled by the CNC. This character is replaced by a space. Subprogram xxxx is not called by any program. gram is, however, output to a memory card file. This pro-
l:W4502
I:W4570
I:W4600
-269-
5.10 J : DECOMPILATION
5.10.1 Number J:F-2100 DATA:-, SYSTEMx J:F-2101 PMC SERIES IS DIFFERENT FROM XxXx MEMORY CARD FORMAT FILE. XxXx MEMORY CARD FORMAT FILE NOT FOUND. MISMATCHED PASSWORD. XxXx MEMORY CARD FORMAT FILE READ ERROR. XXXX SOURCE PROGRAM WRITE ERROR. Error Message THERE IS AN UNDEFINED INSTRUCTION. THERE IS NO SPE INSTRUCTION AT THE BOTTOM OF THE SUBPROGRAM. THE NUMBER OF SYMBOL DATA IN SOURCE PROGRAM EXCEEDS THE LIMIT. ID CODE (l/O MODULE) ERROR.(ADDRESS XXXX) Contents There is a failed instruction or an instruction that cannot be used with the selected program type. There is a subprogram in the selected program that does not end with the SPE instruction. The symbol data size in a selected program exceeded the systemdefined limitbefore the program was executed. The program thus cannot be executed; reduce the symbol data size. An invalid ID code is specified at address xxxx in the l/O module data. The program cannot be executed; prepare a valid memory card file.
Fatal error
Message FUNCTION CODE ERROR. Contents The function code specified in the memory card file does not match that defined in the system. The files function code appears immediately after DATA; the systems function code after SYSTEM. Install valid system data. The program specified in memory card file xxxx does not match the selected program type. Select a valid program. Specified memory card file xxxx does not exist. Create the file. The entered password is invalid. Enter the password correctly. Memory card file xxxx cannot be read. The file is invalid. Data cannot be written to source program xxxx.
J:E-3200
J:E-3300
-270-
Warning Message THE SIZE OF LADDER PROGRAM IS TOO LARGE. Contents The number of steps defined in a subprogram in the ladder program exceeded the maximum number that can be specified for the selected program type. The subprogram is output to the source program. Make necessary corrections by editing the ladder diagram. xxxx net comment pointers do not correspond to any net comment character string. These net comment pointers are not output to the source program. Edit the ladder diagram as necessary. xxxx net comment character strings do not correspond to any net comment pointer. These net comment character strings are deleted. Edit the ladder diagram as necessary. xxxx identical net comment pointers have been found. Character strings are copied so that the same net comment character strings have the same net comment pointers. Step number xxxx is assigned to two or more different steps. Edit the step sequence as necessary. The total number of data items exceeded the system-defined limit when the symbol data merge operation reached the indicated symbol data (address: xxxx/symbol: xxxx). Data subsequent to this symbol data is not output to the source program. xxxx symbol data items are defined for the same address. Either the source data or the memory card data becomes valid, depending on the setting of the symbol merge option. The symbol character string defined in the indicated symbol data (address: xxxx/symbol: xxxx) is already defined at another address. This symbol data is not output to the source program. The indicated symbol data (address: &symbol: xxxx) was found to be invalid as a result of the IEC-cornpliant symbol character string check. This symbol data is not output to the source program. To output it to the source file, change the setting in the %%%FLSET.CNF file. The symbol data containing symbol xxxx contains an invalid address. This symbol data is not output to the source program. The operator panel specification in the system parameter data is invalid. Processing continues while ignoring the operator panel specification. The R/D extension address cannot be used because the PMC version of PMC-RC is earlierthan 3. Change the PMC version in the system parameter. The header section of memory card file xxxx is invalid. However, processing continues. The file settings have returned to the defaults. The settings in the OPTION file of the selected program cannot be read. Create a valid file or modify the file settings. The option reset function key may be used. Symbol character check is not performed. The settings in the %%%FLSET.CNF file cannot be read. Create a valid file or modify the file settings. When this check is not made, processing may be continued even withoui making the changes.
J:W4101
J:W4102
XXXX UNUSED NET COMMENT STRINGS FOUND. XXXX DUPLICATED NET COMMENT POINTER FOUND. THE STEP NUMBER OF XXXX IS USED TWICE OR MORE. THE NUMBER OF SYMBOL DATA EXCEEDS THE LIMIT. (ADDRESS XXXX, SYMBOL XXXX)
J:W4103
J:W4104 J:W4200
J:W4201
XXXX SYMBOL DATA AT DUPLICATED ADDRESS FOUND. SAME SYMBOL EXISTS. (ADDRESS XXXX. SYMBOL XXXX)
J:W4202
J:W4203
J:W4204
SYMBOL DATA ADDRESS ILLEGAL (SYMBOL XXXX) ILLEGAL OPERATOR PANEL (SYSTEM PARAMETER). PROCEED TO DECOMPILE USING NO. THIS MEMORY CARD FORMAT FILE IS NOT FOR EXPANDED R/D ADDRESS. XXXX MEMORY CARD FORMAT FILE ILLEGAL. OPTION READ FAILED. SE-I-I-ING HAS CHANGED INTO DEFAULT.
J:W4300
J:W4301
J:W4800 J:W4900
J:W4901
-271-
Message
INSUFFICIENT INSUFFICIENT MEMORY. DISK SPACE.
Contents
NOT FOUND XxXx FILE. NOT FOUND XxXx SOURCE PROGRAM. FILE I/O ERROR. 1SET-UP FILE BROKEN. I
1ILLEGAL OPTION(S).
INSUFFICIENT PARAMETER(S).
I
Required system or functional instruction parameters are not specified. The functional instruction contains more parameters than are required.
1ILLEGAL IDCODE.
EXPECTED TERMINATOR. PMC SERIES IS DIFFERENT FROM SOURCE-PROGRAM. EXPECTED IDCODE. ILLEGAL PARAMETER(S). CREATE TEMPORARY FILE(S) IN CURRENT DIRECTORY. NOT SPECIFIED ENVIRONMENTAL VARIABLE TMP. ILLEGAL NAME OF SET-UP FILE.
I I I
-272-
Error
Message XXXX FILE CANNOT EXECUTE. XXXX SYMBOL 8 COMMENT DATA BROKEN. CANNOT BE HANDLE DATA TYPE %@2-C. CANNOT CONVERT FILES OF THE PMC SERIES SET UP THE SYSTEM. ;;Z;OT OVERWRITE EXISTING A bit address is specified in the byte address parameter of the functional instruction. A byte address is specified for the basic instruction. An output module is specified as the input addressof the I/O module data. An input module is specified as the output address of the I/O module data. A parameter prohibited address is specified as the address parameter of the functional instruction. The mnemonic of extended symbol %@2-C is converted when %%%FLSET.CNF is a FORMAT-A/B file. Contente
CANNOT SPECIFY BIT ADDRESS OF PARAMETER. CANNOT SPECIFY BYTE ADDRESS ON BASIC INSTRUCTION. CANNOT SPECIFY OUTPUT MODULE AT INPUT ADDRESS. CANNOT SPECIFY INPUT MODULE AT OUTPUT ADDRESS. CANNOT SPECIFY THE ADDRESS PROHIBITED USING AS PARAMETER. CANNOT SPECIFY THE BIT ADDRESS. CANNOT SPECIFY THE BYTE ADDRESS. CANNOT SPECIFY THE INPUT ADDRESS. CANNOT SPECIFY THE INPUT ADDRESS WITH COIL. CANNOT SPECIFY THE ODD ADDRESS. EXPECTED A MULTIPLE OF 2. EXPECTED A MULTIPLE OF 5. EXPECTED ADDRESS. EXPECTED FUNCTION NUMBER. EXPECTED PARAMETER(S). IDCODE NOT FOUND IN XxXx. ILLEGAL ADDRESS. ILLEGAL ADDRESS IN DATA TABLE. ILLEGAL ADDRESS OF PARAMETER. ILLEGAL CHARACTER(S). ILLEGAL SOURCE-PROGRAM NAME.
K:E-3110 K:E3111 K:E-3112 K:E-3113 K:E-3114 K:E-3117 K:E-3118 K:E-3119 K:E-3120 K:E-3121 K:E-3122 K:E-3123 K:E-3124 K:E-3125 K:E-3126 K:E-3127
An output prohibited address is specified as the output address parameter of the functional instruction. An output prohibited address is specified for the coil, An odd-number prohibited address is specified as an oddnumber address. The system parameter contains a value that is other than a multiple of 2. The system parameter contains a value that is other than a multiple of 5. The basic instruction has no address.
An invalid address or an address that cannot be specified is specitied in the symbol and comment data, or message data. An invalid address is specified in the functional instruction data table. An invalid address is specified in the functional instruction address parameter. The system parameter, title data, symbol and comment data, or message data contains invalid character data.
-273-
Number K:E-3128 K:E-3129 K:E-3130 K:E-3131 K:E-3132 K:E-3133 K:E-3134 K:E-3135 K:E-3136 K:E-3137 K:E-3138 K:E3139 K:E3140 K:E-3141 K:E-3142 K:E-3143 K:E-3144 K:E-3145
Message ILLEGAL MNEMONIC FILE NAME. ILLEGAL PARAMETER NUMBER. ILLEGAL TITLE NUMBER. ILLEGAL VALUE. ILLEGAL VALUE IN BASE DATA. ILLEGAL VALUE IN GROUP DATA. ILLEGAL VALUE IN SLOT DATA. ILLEGAL VALUE OF PARAMETER. INCLUDE KANA OR KANJI CHARACTER(S). INPUT MNEMONIC FILE NAME. 1uNAMu: SOURCE-PROGRAM INVALID A NUMBER OF CONVERT DATA. INVALID FUNCTIONS NAME.
Contents
The system parameter contains an invalid data number. The data number of the data identifier is invalid. The system parameter contains an invalid value. An invalid value is specified in the base data of the I/O module data. An invalid value is specified in the group data of the I/O module data. An invalid value is specified in the slot data of the I/O module data. An invalid value is specified in the data table of the functional instruction.
INVALID FUNCTION NUMBER. INVALID MODULE NAME. RETURN STATUS FROM SPAWN IS E2BIG(=7). INVALID PMC SERIES OF SPECIFIED SOURSE-PROGRAM. INVALID QUALIFIER. The system parameter, title data, symbol and comment data, ladder, or I/O module data is followed by an invalid character. The module name of the I/O module data is invalid.
K:E3146 K:E-3147 K:E-3148 K:E-3149 K:E-3150 K:E-3151 K:E-3152 K:E-3153 K:E-3154 K:E-3155 K:E-3156 K:E-3157 K:E-3158
LACK OF XXXX FILE. MESSAGE DATA TOO LARGE. MNEMONIC FILE NOT FOUND. NOT ENOUGH PARAMETER(S). NOT FOUND BASE DATA. NOT FOUND GROUP DATA. NOT FOUND MODULE NAME. NOT FOUND SLOT DATA. NOT FOUND XxXx PROCESS INTERFACE FILE. NOT FOUND XXXX SOURCEPROGRAM MANAGEMENT FILE. NOT FOUND XXXX SUB PROGRAM FILE. OUT OF ADDRESS LIMITS. The address of the mnemonic data or I/O module data is specified. Required system or functional instruction parameters are not specified. The base data of the I/O module is not found. The group data of the I/O module is not found. The module name of the l/O module is not found. The slot data of the I/O module is not found.
OUT OF ADDRESS LIMITS IN DATA An out-of-range address is specified in the functional TABLE. instruction data table.
-274-
Number K:E-3159
bmge OUT OF ADDRESS LIMITS OF ADDRESS. OUT OF ADDRESS LIMITS OF PARAMETER. OUT OF PARAMETER VALUE.
Contents An out-of-range address is specified as a message setting address. An out-of-range address is specified in the functional
I instruction parameter.
/ OUT OF VALUE.
OUT OF VALUE IN BASE DATA. OUT OF VALUE IN DATA TABLE. OUT OF VALUE IN GROUP DATA. OUT OF VALUE IN SLOT DATA. PLEASE SHORTEN FILE NAME. PROCESS ERROR. SOURCE-PROGRAM NOT FOUND.
K:E-3166
SPECIFIED CONVERT DATA NOT FOUND.(XXXX) SPECIFY THE VALUE(SLOT) EXCEPT 0 AT I/O UNIT-B XxXx. SYMBOL DATA COUNT OVER. SYMBOL DATA NOT FOUND. Although comment data exists, there is no symbol data. Only symbol or comment data was converted to the address.
SYMBOL OR COMMENT DATA FOUND. THE SAME GROUP,BASE,AND SLOT ARE ALREADY SPECIFIED. TOO LONG STRINGS. TOO MANY CHARACTERS IN 1 LINE.
I
The group, base, and slot data of the I/O module data all have the same number. The length of the system parameter, message data, or title data exceeds the maximum. The number of characters entered on a line of the system parameter, message data, title data, symbol and comment mnemonic data, mnemonic data, or I/O module data exceeds the limit. functional instruction contains more parameters than 1The are required.
(TOO MANY PARAMETERS. TOTAL VALUE OF BASE AND SLOT IS OVER. UNDEFINED INSTRUCTION.
I
The sum of the base data and slot data values of the l/O module data exceeds the maximum. The data contains an undefined instruction. An address is specified in a location where it is not required. A parameter is specified !or an instruction that requires no parameters. A nonexistent data number is specified for a system parameter or data identifier. An attempt to register symbol and comment data failed. The
I---K:E-3194
K:E-3195
I Doubkbyte
symbol data contains a double-byte character. characters cannot be used in symbol data. I
-275-
Message
COMMENT DATA NOT FOUND. DATA NOT FOUND. DELETED KANJI CHARACTERS. F)PECTED CONTROL CONDlTlON ILLEGAL CHARACTERS ARE SPECIFIED AT XxXx. ILLEGAL OP.PANEL(PARAMETER). PROCEED TO DISCOMPILE USING NO. ILLEGAL SYMBOL. INCLUDE KANA OR KANJI CHARACTER(S). INCLUDE KANA OR KANJI CHARACTER(S) IN COMMENT DATA. LOGICAL OPERATED WITH UNUSED REGISTER(S). LOGICAL PRODUCT REMAINS IN REGISTER(S). MESSAGE DATA INCLUDE KANA OR KANJI CHARACTERS AT XXXX. NOT ENOUGH CONTROL CONDITION (S). NOT FOUND DATA AT XXXX ADDRESS. NOT FOUND PARAMETER NUMBERED XXXX. NOT FOUND TITLE NUMBERED xxxx. NOT FOUND XXXX PMGCS NOT USED NET COMMENT POINTER EXIST. XXXX OUTPUT UNUSED REGISTER(S). OVERWROTE EXISTING DATA. INVALID QUALIFIER. FILE.
Contents
Only symbol data was convened to the address. The system parameter, title data, symbol and comment data, message data, or I/O module data does not exist.
instruction.
System parameter OP.PANEC contains an invalid value; the value is converted to NO. The symbol data is nonstandard (check levet-1). MAT-C only) The message data contain a doubltiyte (For FOR-
character.
Comment data containing a double-byte character was converted without the doubltiyte character cooversion option (J option). An operation was performed using a register that is not registered in the ladder data. A register exists that has not been output to the ladder data. Message data xxxx contains a double-byte katakana character. or single-byte
Control conditions required for the functional instruction are not specified. No message is defined for address xxxx.
--
An invalid character follows the end code % of the system parameter, title data, symbol and comment data, ladder data, message data, or I/O module data.
K:W4121 K:W4122
REGISTERS OVERFLOW. SOME GARBAGE DATA ARE FOUND AT END OF LADDER DATA. SPECIFY SAME GROUP,BASE, AND SLOT. SPECIFY SAME NUMBER(GROUP) AT I/O UNIT-B AS I/O UNIT-A. During conversion to Format-B, data that does not belong to level 1 to 3, or to any subprogram, is found. This indicates that there is data subsequent to the last SPE. The group, base, and slot data of the I/O module data al have the same number.
K:W4123 K:W4124
-276-
Mesaage SPECIFY THE VALUE(BASE) EXCEPT 0 AT I/O UNIT-B. THE FOLLOWING DATA OF XXXX WERE DELETED, BECAUSE OF EXCEEDING THE LIMIT. TOO MANY CONTROL CONDITIONS. UNEXPECTED COIL(S). UNEXPECTED CONTROL CONDITION(S). REDEFINITION OF ADDRESS DATA. The functional conditions.
Contents
instruction
A coil was specified when not required by the functional instruction, A basic instruction was specified in a functional instruction for which no control conditions are required. Two or more symbol definitions exist for a single address. When the start code of thesymbol data is%O2, the symbol definition must not be specified more than once. The second and subsequent definitions are ignored. For information relating to the start code, see Section 4.5.8.3. The same symbol is specified for two or more different addresses. Symbols other than the first specified symbol are replaced by spaces. The character string length of the symbol data exceeds the maximum (six characters for FORMAT-A and FORMAT-B; 16 characters for FORMAT-C). The symbol data is replaced by spaces. The comment data length exceeds 30 characters. The comment data is replaced by spaces. Two or more different symbols are specified for the same address. (For FORMAT-C, an identical symbol may be specified in more than one location.) Symbols other than that specified first are replaced by spaces. Two or more diierent character strings are specified for the same relay comment at the same address. (For FORMAT-C, an identical character string may be specified in more than one location.) Relay comments other than that specified first are replaced by spaces. Two or more different character strings are specified for the same coil comment at the same address. (For FORMAT-C, an identical character string may be specified in more than one location.) Coil comments other than that specified first are replaced by spaces. Two or more different character strings are specified for the same comment title at the same address. (For FORMAT-C, an identical character string may be specified in more than one location.) Comment titles other than that specified first are deleted. The relay comment data length exceeds 16 characters. (For FORMAT-C only) The relay comment data is replaced by spaces. The coil comment data length exceeds 30 characters. (For FORMAT-C only) The coil comment data is replaced by spaces. The comment title data length exceeds 30 characters. (For FORMAT-C only) The comment title data is replaced by spaces.
K:W4131
K:W4132
K:W4133 K:W4134
TOO LONG STRINGS FOR COMMENT DATA. SYMBOL DATA ALREADY EXIST
K:W4135
K:W4136
K:W4137
K:W4138
TOO LONG STRINGS FOR RELAY COMMENT DATA. TOO LONG STRINGS FOR COIL COMMENT DATA. TOO LONG STRINGS FOR COMMENT TITLE DATA.
K:W4139
K:W4140
-277-
5.12 L : INPUT/OUTPUT
5.12.1 Number L:E-3106 L:E-3101 L:E-3102 L:E-3103 L:E-3104 L:E-3105 L:E-3106 L:E-3107 Error Message NOT EXIST XxXx FILE. ROM ID UNMATCH ERROR FILE OPEN ERROR FILE READ ERROR FILE WRITE ERROR FILE CLOSE ERROR INVALID RECEIVE DATA TIME OUT ERROR File xxxx does not exist. The currently set cassette or module does not match the currently selected machine model. The specified file cannot be opened. The specified file cannot be read. Data cannot be written to the specified file. The specified file cannot be closed. Data other than an IS0 code has been received. No response was received within a specified period after the PC issued an instruction. Check the destinations power source, settings, cable connections and parameters (baud rateand stop bit), and whetherthe contents of CONFIGSYS are valid. Access has been interrupted. The tile contents do not match the ROM data. The control code is invalid. The contents of the first record are invalid. The ROM data cannot be comoressed. The ROM file data is invalid. The ROM file exceeds the size of ROM itself. The ROM file format is invalid. The ROM parity of the specified file is invalid. The ROM count is invalid. The ROM file cannot be opened. The work file cannot be opened. The work file cannot be initialized. The work file cannot be closed. The S record format is invalid. A seek operation cannot be performed for the work file. Data cannot be written to the work file. Data cannot be written to the ROM file. The work file cannot be read. The ROM file cannot be read. The ROM file format is invalid. The EROM is mounted improperly. An error was detected during EROM diagnosis. The EROM is faulty. The EROM data does not match the ROM file contents. Data cannot be written because the EROM is not deleted. The EROM is not yet deleted. The number of data items is invalid. Contents
L:E-3108 L:E-3109 L:E-3110 L:E-3120 L:E-3121 L:E-3122 L:E-3123 L:E-3124 L:E-3125 L:E-3126 L:E-3150 L:E-3151 L:E-3152 L:E-3153 L:E-3154 L:E-3155 L:E-3156 L:E-3157 L:E-3158 L:E-3159 L:E-3160 L:E-3180 L:E-3181 L:E-3182 L:E-3183 L:E-3184 L:E-3185 L:E-3186
ACCESS CANCELED FILE-ROM UNMATCH ERROR CONTROL CODE ERROR FIRST RECORD INFORMATION ERROR ROM DATA CANT CONDENSE ERROR PART OF ROM DATA INVALID ROM FILE > ROM ERROR ROM FILE FORMAT ERROR ROM PARITY ERROR OF APPOINT FILE ROM COUNT ERROR ROM FILE OPEN ERROR WORK FILE OPEN ERROR WORK FILE INITIALIZE ERROR WORK FILE CLOSE ERROR S RECORD FORMAT ERROR WORK FILE SEEK ERROR WORK FILE WRITE ERROR ROM FILE WRITE ERROR WORK FILE READ ERROR ROM FILE READ ERROR ROM FILE FORMAT ERROR ROM SET ERROR DIAGNOSIS ERROR EROM OUT LEVEL ERROR COMPARE ERROR DATA FILE WRITE ERROR BLANK CHECK ERROR DATA SEND ERROR
-278-
Number L:E-3187 L:E-3188 L:E-3189 L:E-3190 L:E-3191 L:E-3192 L:E-3193 L:E-3194 L:E-3195 L:E-3196 L:E-3197 L:E-3198 L:E-3199 L:E-3200 L:E-3201 L:E-3202 L:E-3203 L:E-3204 L:E-3205 L:E-3206 L:E-3207 L:E-3208 L:E-3209 L:E-3210 L:E-3211 L:E-3212 L:E-3213 L:E-3214 L:E-3215 L:E-3216 L:E-3217 L:E-3218 L:E-3219 L:E-3220
Mewage
I
The writer is in use.
PARITY ERROR ROM WRITER IS OCCAPIED ROM TYPE ERROR COMPARE ERROR ADDRESS = , INPUT DATA = . FILE DATA = FL10 _ATDAT FILE FORMAT ERROR. HIT ANY KEY. MEMORY CARD ERROR NUMBER ERROR OF INPUT PARAMETER NO.3 PARAMETER ERROR INSUFFICIENT MEMORY
I
An error occurred during memory card format conversion. An error occurred during memory card format conversion. The third parameter specified for memory card format con-
I version is invalid.
There is insufficient memory to activate memory card format conversion. The fourth parameter specified for memory card format conversion is invalid. The activated machine is other than a model that can perform memory card format conversion. The ROM count for memory card format conversion is invalid (the count falls outside the allowable range). The ROM count for memory card format conversion is invalid (the file size falls outside the allowable range). The machine model setting tile cannot be read. Memory card format conversion cannot be initialized. The memory card format conversion file does not exist. The memory card format conversion file cannot be read. There is insufficient free space on the disk to activate memory card format conversion. There is insufficient memory to activate memory card format conversion. The memory card format conversion file cannot be created. The work file for memory card format conversion cannot be opened. An error occurred upon creating a conversion table for
NO.4 PARAMETER ERROR INVALID PMC TYPE INVALID ROM COUNT(OUT OF CASSEl-TE SIZE) INVALID ROM COUNT(OUT OF FILE SIZE) PMC TYPE FILE READ ERROR INITIALIZE ERROR NOT EXIST FILE FILE READ ERROR INSUFFICIENT DISK SPACE OUT OF MEMORY NOT MAKE FILE NOT OPEN WORK FILE CONVERT TABLE MAKE ERROR
I memory card format conversion. 1An I/O error occurred for the machine model settina file.
I 1
The machine model setting file was destroyed during an l/O operation. I The child process cannot be executed. The ROM file format is invalid. A seek operation cannot be performed for the specified file. The specified file cannot be read. -I The specified file cannot be opened. The source file for which format conversion is to be performed does not exist. The ROM count for memory card format conversion is invalid (the ROM size falls outside the allowable range). I The file size cannot be obtained. The file size cannot be changed.
-279-
-280-
Number L:E-3336 L:E-3339 L:E-3340 L:E-3341 L:E-3342 L:E-3343 L:E-3344 LIE-3345 L:E-3350 L:E-3351 L:E-3352 L:E-3353 L:E-3354 L:E-3355 L:E-3356
MeJ=s((e INVALID X PARAMETER IN TEXT FILE ERROR OF MODE COMMAND I==;T INITIALIZE IS COMPLETE ;;;;;RARY FILE FORMAT
Contents X Parameter in the text file is invalid. The MODE command cannot be executed. The port has been successfully initialized. The temporary file format is invalid. The work file cannot be deleted (the pathname is invalid). The work file cannot be deleted (the specified file is not found). The specified machine model is an undefined PMC model. Port initialization failed. A port overrun occurred (detected by the I/O port status check). A parity error occurred (detected check). by the I/O port status
COULD NOT DELETE TMPORARY FILE(FOR INVALID PASS NAME) COULD NOT DELETE TMPORARY FILE(FOR COULD NOT FIND FILE) UNKNOWN PMC TYPE PORT INITIALIZE ERROR PORT ERROR(OVER RUN) PORT ERROR(PARTY) PORT ERROR(FRAMING) PORT ERROR (BREAK INTERRUPT) PORT ERROR (TIME OUT) PORT ERROR (DATA OUTPUT) TIMER SET/CANCEL ERROR
A framing error occurred (detected by the l/O portstatus check). A break interrupt error occurred (detected by the l/O port status check). A time out error occurred (detected by the l/O port status check). A data transmission error occurred (detected by the l/O port status check). The system timer is invalid. Change the data in the text file (FLIO_AT.DAT). For details, see the comment section of FLIO_AT.DAT. - Unpermitted character is used in specified program name. - The program name is over 8 characters. Forrnat-AIB source program is specified. Specify F0mat-C source program.
L:E-3400 L:E-3401 L:E-3402 L:E-3403 L:E-3404 L:E-3500 L:E-3501 L:E-3502 L:E-3503 L:E-3504 L:E-3505 L:E-3506 L:E-3507 L:E-3508 L:E-3509
ILLEGAL XXXX PROGRAM NAME. SOURCE PROGRAM TYPE IS DIFFERENT. XXXX FILE I/O ERROR. UNKNOWN PMC SERIES. XXXX DIRECTORY DOES NOT EXIST. NOT EXIST XxXx pLRf;ARAMETER FILE. COUNT
Specified source programs PMC type is unknown. Specified directory for backup does not exist. File xxxx does not exist. The number of input parameters is invalid. The machine model label of the input parameter is invalid. The data file cannot be opened. The data file cannot be read. The source file for which format conversion formed cannot be opened. The destination opened. is to be percannot be
INPUT PARAMETER MACHINE LABEL NAME ERROR DATA FILE OPEN ERROR DATA FILE READ ERROR CONVERT SOURCE FILE OPEN ERROR ;;;;RT OBJECT FILE OPEN
PARAMETER COUNT ERROR IN DATA FILE PARAMETER ERROR IN DATA FILE INVALID DATA FILE INFORMATION
The numberof parameters specified in the data file is invalid. The data file contains an invalid parameter. The contents of the data file are invalid.
-281-
1 Number
Mesaage
Contents The source file cannot be read. There is insufficient memory to continue processing. The ROM file format is invalid. Data cannot be written to the destination file. I The data file does not exist. Conversion has been canceled. There is insufficient free space on the disk to continue processing. File xxxx does not exist. The number of input parameters is invalid. The machine model label for the input parameter is invalid.
CONVERT SOURCE FILE READ L:E-3511 L:E-3512 MEMORY ALLOCATE ERROR E;;;kRT SOURCE FILE FORMAT
I I
CONVER OBJECT FILE WRITE ERROR DATA FILE DOSNT EXIST COCNVERT CANCEL INSUFFICIENT DISK SPACE
NOT EXIST XXXX FILE. INPUT PARAMETER COUNT ERROR INPUT PARAMETER MACHINE LABEL NAME ERROR
1 L:E-3603 L:E-3604 L:E-3605 L:E-3696 L:E-3607 L:E-3608 1 L:E-3609 L:E-3610 L:E-3611 L:E-3612 L:E-3613 L:E-3614 L:E-3615
CONVERT OBJECT FILE OPEN ERROR PARAMETER COUNT ERROR IN DATA FILE PARAMETER ERROR IN DATA FILE
DATA FILE DOSNT EXIST COCNVERT CANCEL INSUFFICIENT DISK SPACE SUM CHECK ERROR OF S RECORD rFORMAT ERROR OF SO RECORD
I I
L:E-3516 L:E-3617 L:E-3618 L:E-3619 L:E-3620 L:E-3621 L:E-3622 L:E-3700 L:E-3701 L:E-3702
1The SO record format is invalid. ( The machine model code for the SO record is invalid.
A data conversion error occurred.
-282-
Number L:E-3703 L:E-3704 L:E-3705 L:E-3766 L:E-3707 L:E-3708 L:E-3709 L:E-3710 L:E-3711 L:Ei3712 L:E-3713 L:E-3714 L:E-3715 L:E-3716 L:E-3717 L:E-3718 L:E-3719 L:E-3720 L:E-3721 L:E-3722 L:E-3723 L:E-3724 L:E-3725 L:E-3726 L:E-3727 L:E-3728 L:E-3729 L:E-3730 L:E-3731 L:E-3732 L:E-3733 L:E-3734 L:E-3735 L:E-3736 L:E-3737
Messaurge NO.4 PARAMETER ERROR INVALID PMC TYPE INVALID ROM COUNT (OUT OF CASSETTE SIZE) INVALID ROM COUNT (OUT OF FILE SIZE) PMC TYPE FILE READ ERROR INITIALIZE ERROR NOT EXIST FILE FILE READ ERROR INSUFFICIENT DISK SPACE OUT OF MEMORY NOT MAKE FILE NOT OPEN WORK FILE CONVERT TABLE MAKE ERROR PMC TYPE l/O ERROR BROKEN PMC TYPE FILE IMPOSSIBLE PROSESS ERROR ROM FILE TYPE ERROR FILE SEEK ERROR FILE READ ERROR FILE OPEN ERROR NOT EXIST SOURCE CONVERT FILE INVALID ROM COUNT (OUT OF ROM SIZE) FILE SIZE GAIN ERROR FILE SIZE CHANGE ERROR DATA SEEK ERROR ROM INFORMATION ERROR FILE WRITE ERROR OBJECT FILE I/O ERROR DATA MAX OVER $-TEA SIZE IS LESS THAN ROM INVALID DATA SIZE OF MEMORY CARD INVALID MEMORY CARD FILE INVALID ROM COUNT IN ROM FILE ROM PARITY ERROR PARAMETER ERROR (MEMORY CARD TYPE)
Contents The fourth parameter specified for memory card format conversion is invalid. The activated machine is other than a model that supports memory card format conversion. The ROM count for memory cardformat conversion is invalid (the count falls outside the allowable range). The ROM count for memory cardformat conversion is invalid (the file size falls outside the allowable range). The machine model setting file cannot be read. Memory card format conversion cannot be initialized. The memory card format conversion file does not exist. The memory card format conversion file cannot be read. There is insufficient free space on the disk to activate memory card format conversion. There is insufficient memory to activate memory card format conversion. The memory card fom?at conversion file cannot be created. The work file for memory card format conversion cannot be opened. An error occurred upon creating a conversion memory card format conversion. table for
An I/O error occurred for the machine model setting file. The machine model setting file was destroyed during an I/O operation. The child process cannot be executed. The ROM file format is invalid. A seek operation cannot be performed for the specified file. The specified file cannot be read. The specified file cannot be opened. The source file for which format conversion formed does not exist. is to be per-
The ROM count for memory card format conversion is invalid (the ROM size falls outside the allowable range). The file size cannot be determined. The file size cannot be changed. A seek operation cannot be performed in the file data section Data cannot be written to the ROM file data section. Data cannot be written to the specified file. An I/O error occurred in the object file. The amount of data exceeds the allowed maximum. Execution cannot be continued because the data size i: smaller than that of the count. The size of the memory card data section is invalid. The memory card file is invalid (the identification invalid). The ROM count in the ROM file is invalid. The parity value in the ROM file is invalid. There is an invalid parameter (memory card format). data i:
-283-
5.12.2 Warning
Number L:W4100 Message ROM PARITY WARING OF APPOINT FILE, CONTINUE TO TRANSFER? (Y/N) ROM PARITY WARING OF APPOINT FILE XXXX IS A PROGRAM OF DIFFERENT PMC TYPE. * NORMAL END * D _PROGOPT -DRAM UNMATCH * PARITY UNMATCH * CASSETTE SIZE = XXXX * ROM COUNT = XXXX Content8
I
Restoring program PMC type and system PMC type is I same. Processing ended normally. The DRAM does not match. The parity does not match. Cassette size = xxxx ROM count = xxxx
~~~~I~~;~~IE~~~YT&THE L:W4206 L:W4207 * ADJUST OBJECT FILE SIZE TO ROM COUNT SIZE * ADD OBJECT FILE SIZE (XXXX BYTE)
j The last 120h bytes of the ROM file have been deleted.
The ROM count is appropriate for the object file size. The object file size has been increased by xxxx bytes.
-284-
N:E-3006
LADDER SIZE ERROR PMC CONTROL TYPE BSI (RAl). PROGRAM SIZE ERROR (OPTION). PMC TYPE UNMATCH. NO OPTION (LADDER STEP). THE COMMUNICATION TO PMC IS NOT READY. AN ALARM OCCURS ON PMC. LADDER SIZE OVER (PMC) ERROR STATUS = nn THE PROGRAM IS NOT CORRESPONDING (PMC). STATUS=NN AN ALARM OCCURS ON PMC ERROR STATUS = nn LADDER DATA ERROR (PMC) ERROR STATUS = nn INPUT INVALID OBJECT BUFFER OVER COM FUNCTION MISSING
N:E-3046
N:E-3947
N:E-3048
N:E-3055
-285-
Number N:E-3056
Contents The usage of the ENDl, END2, END3. and END functional instructions is invalid. Check whether these instructions have been entered in the correct order. Data cannot be updated because the ladder program has failed. Input the ladder program again. The usage of the CALL and CALLU functional instructions is invalid. Enter these instructions in the second ladder level, or in a subprogram. TheCALLorCALLUfun&malinsbu&nissper%edbetween the COM (SUB9) and COME functionalinstructions. Do not specify CALL or CALLU between COM and COME. Within the subprogram, the usage of the JMP (SUB1 0) functional instruction is invalid. Check whether the usage of JMP and JMPE (SUB30) is valid. The usage of the SP functional instruction is invalid. Check whether the usage of SP and SPE is valid. The specified subprogram number already exists. . Specify another subprogram number. No subprogram exists. Create a subprogram. The END functional instruction does not exist. Enter the END functional instruction. The number of labels exceeds the allowed maximum. Reduce the number of labels. The specified label number is already in use. Specify another label number. The LBL functional instruction specified by JMPB does noi exist. Enter the LBL functional instruction. The JMPB functional instruction is specified between the COM and COME functional instructions. This instruction cannot be used to perform a jump from between COM and COME. Do not insert JMPB between COM and COME. Or, enterthe LBL functional instruction, together with JMPB, betweenI COM and COME. The JMPB inskuctioncannotjump to other than a subprogram. Ensure that it jumps to a subprogram. The LBL functional instruction specified by JMPC does noi I exist. Enter the LBL functional instruction. The specified LBL functional instruction is specifiec between COM and COME. This instruction cannot be usec to perform a jump from between COM and COME. Do not insert LBL between COM and COME. Or, enter the JMPC functional instruction, together with LBL. behveer COM and COME. The JMPC functional instruction is specified in other than 2 subprogram. Specify the JMPC functional instruction in a subprogram. The LBL functional instruction specified by JMPC exists ir1 a level other than the second ladder level. Enter the LBL functional instruction in the second ladde r level. -
N:E-3056
LADDER BROKEN
N:E-3660
N:E-3061
N:E-3062
SUB PROGRAM MISSING SP NO. DUPLICATE SUB PROGRAM NOTHING END FUNCTION NOTHING LBL COUNT OVER LBL NO. DUPLICATE LBL FUNCTION NOTHING (JMPB)
N:E-3071
N:E-3072 N:E-3073
N:E-3074
N:E-3075
N:E-3076
-286
Message
Contents The entered symbol is not yet defined. Enter a valid symbol name. The ladder program is invalid. Input the ladder program again. An invalid operation was performed (e.g., an attempt was made to create a relay or coil in a functional instruction). Be careful to specify operations correctly. The number of data tables exceeds the allowed maximum. Reduce the number of data tables. There is no free space in the buffer in which editing can be performed. Reduce the size of the net being edited. An unnecessary relay or coil exists. Delete the unnecessary relay or coil. The specified address is not found. Check the specified address. The horizontal lines of the net are not connected. Connect the horizontal lines. Them is an invalii connectionbetween funckonalinstmcticns. Ensure that the connections between functional instructions are specified correctly. No relay or coil exists. Add a relay or coil. The vertical lines of the net are not connected. Connect the vertical lines. No parameters are specified for a functional instruction. Specify the required parameters. No address is specified. Specify an address. The net being edited exceeds the size of the editing buffer. Reduce the size of the net being edited. The net is too large to be displayed. Reduce the size of the net. An invalid net exists. Correct the invalid net. The specified functional instruction is not found. Check the number of the functional instruction. Search for a functional instruction has been performed using the wrong number. Check the number specified for the functional instruction. The MCARD file cannot be opened. Check whether the program name has been entered correctly. Alternatively, the MCARD file may have been destroyed. The symbol file cannot be opened. Check whether the program name has been entered correctly. Alternatively, the source program may have been destroyed. The MCARD file cannot be read. The MCARD file may have been destroyed. An error occurred when reading data from extended memory. Memory management may have been disabled. Reboot the personal computer.
DATA TABLE COUNT OVER EDIT BUFFER OVER RELAY OR COIL FORBIT ADDRESS BIT NOTHING HORIZONTAL LINE ILLEGAL FUNCTION LINE ILLEGAL
RELAY OR COIL NOTHING VERTICAL LINE ILLEGAL PARAMETER NOTHING ADDRESS NOT DETECTED NET TOO LARGE LARGE NET APPEARED ERROR NET FOUND FUNCTION NOT FOUND ILLEGAL FUNCTION NO
N:E-3123
N:E-3124
N:E-3125 N:E-3126
ROM FILE READ ERROR ERROR STATUS = nn ROM FILE READ ERROR (VMEM) ERROR STATUS = nn
-287-
1 Number
Message
Contents There is insufficient memory to perform writing to the MCARD file. Memory management may have been disabled. Reboot the personal computer. Data cannot be written to the MCARD file. Check the amount of free space available on disk, and the name of the program to be saved. The net comment file cannot be opened. Check whether the program name has been entered correctly. Alternatively, the source program may have been destroyed. There is insufficient memory. Reserve an area in conventional memory.
I
IU:E-3131 IU:E-3132
IU:E-3130
ROM FILE WRITE ERROR ERROR STATUS = nn NET COMMENT FILE OPEN ERROR ERROR STATUS = nn
IV:E-3140 V:E-3141
FAIL TO ALLOCATE MEMORY FOR DATA TABLE CONTROL DATA. FAIL TO READ FROM PMC DATA TABLE CONTROL DATA.
An error occurred while reading data table control data from the PMC. Check the connection with the PMC and whether the specified machine model matches that of the connected PMC. An error occurred while writing data table control data to the PMC. Check the connection with the PMC and whether the specified machine model matches that of the connected PMC. An attempt was made to change a value in a data table group, but that data table group is writ+protected. First, checkwhetherthe correct data table group is specified, then set that data table group to write-enabled status. The specified address is not found. Check whether the address is specified correctly. An attempt was made to update or restore the ladder diagram when it had not been modified. An error occurred in the ladder diagram. The system cannot switch to update or monitor. Correct the error in the diagram. There is insuft icient memory. Reserve an area in conventional There is insufficient memory. Reserve an area in conventional memory or on disk.
Y:E-3142
N:E-3143
ADDRESS NOT FOUND. LADDER DIAGRAM HAS NOT BEEN MODIFIED. AN ERROR OCCURS IN THE LADDER DIAGRAM. TEMPORARY FILE LOAD ERROR. NOT ENOUGH PROGRAM MEMORY PROGRAM READ ERROR. NOTENOUGHPROGRAM MEMORY LADDER DIAGRAM HAS BEEN MODIFIED. ;;K;TF!JHI PROGRAM IS
N:E-3153
N:E-3155
memory.
N:E-3158
The system cannot switch to store or monitor because the ladder diagram has been modified. Update the ladder diagram. The specified program does not match that in the PMC memory. Specify the correct program, or load or store the program such that it matches the PMC memory program. The user has canceled the transfer. If the storing of a program is canceled, the program in PMC memory may be destroyed. Store the program again to load it into the PMC. If program loading is canceled, the program remains as is. If the program does not match that in PMC memory, load or store the program such that it matches the PMC memory program. Communication with the PMC has not yet been established. Set up communication with the PMC. The entered password is invalid. Enter a valid password.
N:E-3160
N:E-3161
N:E-3162 N:E-3163
-288-
Number N:E-3164
Message TOO LARGE PROGRAM. NOT ENOUGH PMCS PROGRAM MEMORY INVALID PROGRAM NAME. CUT BUFFER SIZE OVER. CUT BUFFER ALLOCATION ERROR. NET COMMENT CUT ERROR (nn).
Contents The size of the specified program exceeds that of the PMC program memory. Check the sizes of the specified program and the PMC program memory. The program name is invalid. Check the program name. The specified range is too great. Specify a narrower range. There is insufficient memory. Reserve an area in extended memory, or on disk. memory, conventional
N:E-3172
When nn = 1: There is insufficient memory. Reserve an area in extended memory, conventional memory, or on disk. When nn = 2: The net comment file contains invalid data. Check the net comments using the off-tine function. Whennn=l: There is insufficient memory. Reserve an area in extended memory, conventional memory, or on disk. When nn = 2: The net comment file contains invalid data. Check the net comments using the off-line function. Whennn=l: There is insufficient memory. Reserve an area in extended memory, conventional memory, or on disk. When nn = 2: The net comment file contains invalid data. Check the net comments using the off-line function. The net comment file contains erroneous data. Check the net comments using the off-line function. The net comment file contains erroneous data. Check the net comments using the off-tine function. The net comment file contains erroneous data. Check the net comments using the off-line function. The net comment file contains no net comment within the specified range. Check the net comments using the off-line function. - On-line editing function and l/O menu functions are protected. Confirm keep relay. - Data table control data screen is protected. Confinn keep relay. PMC parameter is write protected. Set CNC mode to MDI or emergency stop, or stop the sequence program. PMC parameter is write protected. Set CNC parameter PWE=l , or stop the sequence program. PMC parameter is write protected. Set CNC parameter PWE=l , or set KEY4=1, or stop the sequence program. Signal status is write protected. Confirm keep relay.
N:E-3173
N:E-3174
NET COMMENT APPEND ERROR. NET COMMENT DELETE ERROR. NET COMMENT DATA WRITE ERROR. NOTHING NET COMMENT DATA.
N:E-3183
N:E-3184
WRITE PROTECT. (NOT MDI MODE NOR EMERGENCY STOP.) WRITE PROTECT. (CHECK PWE.) WRITE PROTECT. (CHECK PWE AND KEY4.) WRITE PROTECT.
N:E-3185 N:E-3186
N:E-3187
-289-
e
n
a
AND DECOMPILATION
APPENDIX
AND
(1)
Conditions When
for starting
[ON-LINE
(SELECTED
PROGRAM)] is performed
compilation
or decompilation
to the following
[Conditions/results] The start conditions are determined from the results program. of companng The conditions below. the time under stamps of the files
CONTOL
and MCARD
which
these
are updated
are described
[File updating 0
conditions] file file is updated once the source program has been modified by using the off-
CONTOL
function.
MCARD
file file is updated function once the source program has been input by using the off-line from after
(for example,
a memory-card modifying
or Handy-File program
format
processing
the ladder
function.
[Results] 0 When the CONTOL + Automatic file has the most recent is performed. time stamp
compilation
cases] no compilation is performed after the program is edited by using the off-line
Q)
time stamp
decompilation
[Applicable
cases] is performed function after the ladder program is edited by using the on-line after the program is transferred from the PMC by
input;output is terminated
in)
When both files have the same time stamp * Automatic start processing is not performed.
Al-l
APPENDIX
1 AUTOMATIC
COMPILATION
AND DECOMPILATION
[Applicable cases]
.
.
(Note)
The options applied to automatic compilation conditions, function. are those specified
with [PROGRAM
Before attempting
to select [ON-LINE
Al
-2
APPENDIX
CHANGE
OF EACH SETTING
FILE
is a file of the text form and some is decided, are described there.
of FAPT LADDER
is installed.
can be changed
(Note)
%%%FLSET.CNF
contains
system
operation.
If data
in this manual
may not be
Do not, therefore,
(1) Sample
of %%%FLSET.CNF
;=======================I==============================================
FAPT LADDER Initial Setting File ( 'key word =' <= 9characters ; .============r==============IPI-PIIPrPII============================= ,
; I
lv; .
========
System
information
======E=
ierl=AOBB-9201-J503 Version 01.0; rights=Copyrigth (C) 1991-1995 FANUC LTD.: ======== System Setup ======E lS:
:
editor =* , , ladkey = 1; ;
Text Editor Ladder editing key buffer ( 1 <= ladkey <= 16 ) size
lU:
========
Utility
Information
======= Utility Guidance 61 EXE 6 EXE h EXE 6 EXE 6 EXE 6 EXE 6 EXE 6 EXE h EXE 6 EXE
4 = UTILITY; , Fl = DOS / command.com; F2 = flOadat / FLOADAT; F3 = View result / FLVIEW.BAT %p.err; F4 =Linker / i_lipmcr-pf103400b.tbl; F5 =* F6 =I F7 =; F8 =; F9 =* FlO=; : [EOF]
[Fl] Soft Key Guidance [FZ] Soft Key Guidance [F3] Soft Key Guidance [F4] Soft Key Guidance [F5] Soft Key Guidance [F6] Soft Key Guidance [F7] Soft Key Guidance [FE] Soft Key Guidance [F9] Soft Key Guidance [FlO] Soft Key Guidance
A2 - 1
APPENDIX
2 CHANGE
OF EACH SETTING
FILE
(2) Registering
(a) Function
A tool which is executed initial or off-line menu.= under DOS can be registered in the [UTILITY] function on the
(b)
Key word 11 Utility Information Items F5 = to FlO = are displayed under IJ; For these items, describe the tool to be assigned to each function key. Do not modify is modified, the currently displayed characters, such as V and F5 =. If such a character system does not recognize the assignment.
(c) Format
Tool name displayed on the utility screen to the right of : are assumed to be a comment. w [Fl ] Soft key Guidance & EXE
Characters
Delimiter Function
belween
displayed
name
and command
The maximum number of characters registered tool are as follows: . Tool name : 70 characters . Registered tool : 40 characters
which
can
be used
to specify
the
tool
name
and
(or 35 double-byte
characters)
AZ-2
APPENDIX
3.1
(1)
CONVERSION
OF SEQUENCE
PROGRAM
Differences
Source program
supports
FAPT LADDER-II
I
(Note 1)
source
program
type
FAPT LADDER
FORMAT-B O(Note1)
X
FORMAT-C O(Note1)
source
program
types manual.
For details,
refer
FAPT LADDER
SAMPLE
MANAGEMENT
OF FORMAT-C
FORMAT-C This source program type is used on FAPT LADDER-II. program is organized by below files.
The FORMAT-C
source
c A case of specifying
program
>
c: tc
data y PRG Cy Source program managing file System parameter data file Title data file Symbol & Comment data file Message data file l/O Module data file First level ladder data file Second level ladder data file Third level ladder data file Sub-program ladder data file Sub-program step sequence data file Net comment data file Setting of option Memory card format file
-CONTROL SYSPARAM . TITLE XSYMBOL.xxx MESSAGE IOMODULE LEVEL1 .#LA LEVEL2.#LA LEVEL3.#LA Pyyy.#LA Pzzz.#SS NETCMT.xxx OPTION -. MCARD
(Note
1)
xxxis
yyy,
number
A3 - 1
FORMAT-A This source The source two or more program program source type is only used on FAPT LADDER. is managed programs. using the following names. A single directory can contain
: Ftle managtng
: File storing
: File storing
: File storing
system
data
is the specified
source
program
name.)
FORMAT-B This source A directory program program is created type is only used on FAPT LADDER. with under the specified source names. program A single name. directory In the cannot directory, contain the two or
is managed programs.
the following
more source
- CONTROL
- SYSPARAM
: Ftle managing
File storing File storing File storing File storing File stonng File storing File storing File storing File storing File storing File storing File storing
the source
program
system
parameters
the title data symbols comments comments messages the I10 module ladder ladder ladder ladder data (reserve)
step sequence
IS a subprogram
number.)
143-2
APPENDIX
3 CONVERSION
OF SEQUENCE
PROGRAM
LADDER however,
operating
LADDER-II.
External CNC
devices
Memory-card Handy-File
file
External CNC
devices
Memory-card Handy-File
file
format)
format)
3.2
Conversion
FAPT
Because format
LADDER-II
Source
type
ROM format
Programs by applying
developed
can be converted
(1) Conversion
to a mnemonic file
program file. can be converted to a FAPT LADDER-II program by first converting
A3-3
Convert
a program
to a mnemonic
file, using
the FAPT
LADDER
mnemonic
editing
function,
format also
file
be converted file. format fde, using [MEMORY CARD] of the FAPT to a FAPT LADDER-If program by first
format
a memory-card
function
source file
can also be converted to a FAPT LADDER-II program by first source support file. FORMAT-C source files. Convert the source file type to
it to a FORMAT-C models
FAPT LADDER
FORMAT-C,
(4) Conversion
FAPT LADDER-II
(a) Operation
Select
[OFF-LINE
FUNCTION]
from
the initial
menu,
then
select
F6 (I/O].
The [l/O]
screen appears.
@ Press the c F9> key on the (I.01 screen. The II/O (ROM FILE)] screen appears.
(Note)
key is displayed
The
<F9>
effective.
(@I Selecttng
F2 [READ]
displays
the
II0
(ROM
FILE
> MCARDI
the file.
screen.
Enter
the
then convert
A3-4
APPENDIX 3 CONVERSION
OF SEQUENCE PROGRAM
Fl
KEY KEY
F2
Program
some PMC type sequence program to
to convert
type of it.
3.3.1
editing
PMC type data by changing system
of the system
functional
instructions
and range
of address
are
CNC TYPE
PMC TYPE
Power
Mate-MODEL B
FS IS-MODEL
[Example:
PMC-RB
(1) Set the PMC type to PMC-RB (2) Change (3) Set the the system PMC type parameter to
PMC-RC3
program.
A3 - 5
file (PMC-RB)
file (PMCRC3)
2 BCD
parameter 3 NO
% %@5 x000 1 YO08 1 % %@E 0 0 1 ID16C 4 OD32A % %@5 x000 1 YO08 1 % %@E 0 0 1 IDlCC 4 OD32A
3.3.2
PMCCNC
TYPE
MATERIALS
PROGRAMMING (LADDER
MANUAL
FSnM
CNV.SYM
PMC-LMIM(MMC) (FSO-M)
PM-C - CNV.SYM
-MODEL
(Note)
5).
The converter
file is stored
in the drrectory
APPENDIX
of module
system
floppy
disk (Vol.
A3-6
[Example:
PMC-P -+ PMC-PA
(1) Set PMC type to PMC-P. and convert the original source program to the mnemonic file. (+A.) (2) Set PMC type to PMC-PAl. And input the source program name and select [END] at edit
mode without editing the ladder program.
(7) Complete the text editor, and activate FAPT (8) Set PMC type to PMC-PAl.
(9) Select edit mode, and delete the symbol and comment data. Convert file PM-C - CNV.SYM %@2 A. Original file (PMC-P) %@A %@O
1 2048
% %@l % %@2 % %@3 RD X21.4
WRT 6121.4 RD.NOT X22.3 WRT.NOT 6122.3 SUB 1 SUB 2 WRT G121.4 RD.NOT WRT.NOT SUB 1 SUB 2 b b@E X22.3 6122.3
A3-7
3.3.3
Data
program
program,
by the following
The range
of addresses
to another.
They
may have
to be modified.
of the respective
models.
[Example
& comment
%@2 x000.0
x000.1
%
Insert
ZPX.M ZPY.M
%
%@E
Converting
a step sequence
program
according
to the model
mnemonics
a ladder
program
according program
a ROM ftle is used only when a step sequence for the PMCRC4(STEP by which the source SEC). program is described
is converted
to the source
C: Y DATA f SAMPLERC.
[Procedure] Compile the step sequence a object file. program C: f DATAY SAMPLERB for PMC-RB4 (STEP SEQ)
and create
(Create
C: Y DATAY
SAMPLERB.
MEM)
Create
program
C: Y DATA?
SAMPLERC.
by (1.1, is change
as follows
from command
line.
C: y > RENAME
C: -Y DATA Y SAMPLERB
C: Y DATA Y SAMPLERC
A3-8
(;ii
Select
C: 7 DATA SLSAMPLERC
source
program
screen.
Select
F4 (DECOMPILE)
menu.
The program
is converted. SEQ).
program
the PMCRC4(STEP
3.3.4
a mnimonic
program:
PMC-RB4 of converting
file is suitable.
program program
C: Y DATAY
SAMPLERB
: PMC-RB4 : PMCRC4
(STEP
SEQ)
C: Y DATA Y SAMPLERC
(STEP SEQ).
[Operation
]
the step sequence program C: Y DATAY SAMPLERB and generate the object file. MEM is generated.)
Compile
program,
C: Y DATAY
SAMPLERC.
(STEP SEQ).)
01
Change
the object
Select
C: Y DATAY
SAMPLERC
at Program
selection.
@J Select
F4 key (Decompile).
sequence
program
C:Y DATAY
SAMPLERC
is now
available
for PMC-RC4
(STEP
3.4 3.4.1
This function
A3-9
3.4.1.1
(1) Uploading
Loads the FAPT LADDER mnemonic data into the PC from the P-G via the RS232 port.
FLOADAT
[name
uploaded
data]
When current
name
for receiving
data
already
exists
in the
the following
message
File is exist.
Over write?
<Y/N >
(2)
Downloading Loads the FAPT LADDER mnemonic data into the P-G from the PC via the RS232 port.
I
FLOADAT _ [name of file for storing downloaded data] _ -d (for IBM PC/AT)
As shown
above,
two parameters:
-u: Uploads
data from the P-G to the PC. data from the PC to the P-G.
-d: Downloads
(Note) 3.4.1.2
PC side
The above
parameters
can be specified
with either
lowercase
or uppercase
characters.
Communications
settings
IBM PCAT
senes command)
MODE MODE
COMl: COMl:
IO NC,CNl,Fl,FG,BRlO
(Note 1)
The baud
4800
or 9600. BRlO
However,
note
that when
the PC
the parameter
must be added
(Note 2)
setting
After 2.1
function, 1).
communications
is not fixed.
from
from CNl
of the IO command.
in Appendix
A3-10
-z PC > < PG z= Turn on power. < PG > Enter IO command < PC > IBM PC/AT Series: settings. Enter MODE command < PG > Store transmission settings. ; i IO NC,CNl,Fl,FG(,BRlO) (See Section Settings) Press the [F2] key to select no.2. menu item 2 of Communications
i : : ;
FLOADAT
FILENAME
-u is displayed.
FLOADAT.
Enters waiting
slate.
: < PC > !
LOADER
START
Select
; < PG >
EXECUTING
is displayed.
-z PG > Returns
Complete
is displayed.
followed
by the prompt
During
Operation
procedure
c PC > < PG > Turn on power. c PG > Enter IO command -z PC > IBM PC/AT series command setting key. Select no.2 on the settings.
;
i
IO NC,CNl
,(BRlO,)Fl
,F6
: Enter MODE
(See Section
2 of Communications
waiting
state.
FLOADAT.
;
3egins transmission. transmission. to the menu. Operation Complete IS HIT
FLOADAT
FILENAME Start
-d is displayed.
: -c PC > Output
Zompletes
Complete
is displayed.
followed
by the prompt
is displayed.
A3-11
APPENDIX
3 CONVERSION
OF SEQUENCE
PROGRAM
3.4.1.3
Durinq
Protocol
uploadinq the FLOADAT command is executed begins. on the PC side, a communications received, request is
When issued
DC 3 is sent and
transmission
0 0
DC 1 code is sent to the P-G (data transmlssion Data is received. code is received and reception
request).
(Z$J Completion @
is completed.
DC 3 code is sent.
Transmisston output.
and reception
both
use the
l-byte
machlne-dependent
BIOS
and
Durinq
downloading the P-G issues a transmission request, begins. the P-G enters the waiting state. FLOADAT is
After
activated
sent,
DC 4 is sent and
transmission
The P-G issues DC 1. DC 2 code is sent to the P-G Data is sent. is sent.
8
0
@I DC 4 code
Transmlsslon output.
and reception
both
use the
l-byte
machine-dependent
BIOS
and
3.4.1.4
When issuing effectively
BUSY control
the transmtsslon the DC 1 and speed is faster than In the reception processing, series, BUSY there control is performed by
DC 3 codes.
IBM PC/AT
is no X parameter,
which
A3-12
3.4.1.5
of these
used,
(Note)
shown
speaking,
CR + LF + an end (% etc.)
End codes
within comments
3.4.1.6
(ODH) IS recerved,
it is discarded.
to it in that order.
3.4.1.7
Transmission
Discarded
Valid data -
sent or received,
or DC 4 is sent for
A3-13
3.4.1.8
This software
(1)
When there is an error in the command Error in the file name, Parameter FLOADAT Error FILENAME -u. or -d.
line
(FILNAME,
upload
or download.)
(2)
Cannot
open output
(3) When data not in the FAPT LADDER Wrong data received
format
is sent or received
problem
Start Code error detected or there is a definite problem with the end code
only detects
errors
format. data.
of FAPT LADDER
Messaqes
When
specified
data already
exists
in the current
directory,
the following
File is exist.
A3 - 14
APPENDIX
3 CONVERSION
OF SEQUENCE
PROGRAM
3.4.1.9
1.
Incorrect
2.
Specified
file cannot
be opened.
3.
Data
LADDER
format
was sent
or received.
The followrng
causes
can be considered
errors:
l l l l l
The end code has been omitted The start code has been omitted Garbage Garbage data exists data exists
is A or 0 to 5. was omitted)
of the file.
is completely
errors
is detected,
the current
operation
is canceled.
downloadrng,
if an error
is detected
on the
PC, the
system
will return
to the
DOS
a %, %@E
or other
end code
rt to the
4. Others
When,
data transfer
When
data
transfer
is interrupted
during
uploadrng,
state
until
is restarted. transfer
(To interrupt
the waiting
is Interrupted
during
downloading,
data
becomes
and
data
must be started
A3-15
APPENDIX
4 STANDARD
SYMBOL
DATA
APPENDIX
When a mnemonic standard symbol
STANDARD
file and the standard
SYMBOL
symbol
DATA
it is possible to use the
name provided
by FANUC.
(Note)
The standard
symbol
data is stored
in the directory
APPENDIX
of system
floppy
(Vol. 5).
A4-1
APPENDIX
5 TOOL
FOR CHANGING
MESSAGE
DATA (CHGMES)
APPENDIX
This function
MESSAGE
the message
DATA (CHGMES)
data incorporating sequence
program
of FANUC
.
data from Handy can be replaced file format file. data, if both message data with this extracted
only message
data in CNC(PMC)
size are the same. This tool is usefull when it is necessary example: Supporting multi-lingual to use some message data files in one ladder program.(For
message.)
< Method
of Message
size Check > IS output when the source program is compiled. ladder and the ladder for
(1)
symbol
top address
of the original
changing
to be the same value. for changrng the same check the message data execute data size. with the compare file, then this tool
(2)
of the message
<Applied
FANUC
1.
(1
PROCEDURE
OF THE MESSAGE
ladder file of handy operation with the
DATA CHANGING
to the NC by using the.memory card or
by loadtng
the output
(I l/O] screen).
2.
OPERATING
ENVIRONMENT
operating environment for this tool.
It IS necessary
to use following
(1)
Memory 235Kbytes LADDER. or more main memory is required when activating this function without FAPT
(2)
Temporary
files generates following variable temporary TMP files files for work area on the drive/directory which
This function
temporary IMP
temporary
A5 - 1
to use following
65KBytes
TOTAL
133KBytes
3.
INSTALLATION
copy EXE-FILE (_CHGMES.EXE) to any directory from FAPT LADDER system floppy
Please
disk(Vol.3). Key in * CHGMES on the Installed directory, then following files are generated.
. ASC2lMG.EXE
RB3BASIC.SFM are used to confirm
. IMG2ASC.EXE . RB3MES.SFM
the installation
: :
Execute example
of this function
4.
ACTIVATION
command at the DOS prompt activated in the utility.(No.9 of FAPT LADDER main
in whrch this tool is installed. the directory when the PATH is set.)
CHGMES
[INPUT
FILE j
[OUTPUT
FILE]
[PMC TYPE]
( [COMPARE
of a dummy
FILE] ) ladder
<return >
and message file. to a handy file data
INPUT FILE
ladder
file using FAPT LADDER. file created data. data in the CNC memory can be by this tool.
OUTPUT
FILE
only message
PMC TYPE
Error will occur at key in other COMPARE (Optional) FILE : : Basic message Please This ladder
file (Handy
refer to the Fig.Operation tool compares FILE that only to message determine the message
the
INPUT
and you
the can
if there will be
is a match. correctry
without
FILE to CNC.
A5-2
< Outline
of Operation
Basic message VI
ladder t
+ COMPILATION
top map
INPUT/OUTPUT
(F4:FLOPPY
CASSETTE
Handy
File)
FLOPPY
lb
CNC
Loading
shanging 1 CHGMES %l
ROM data(Using
(Note)
x2
FLOPPY
El:
FS15-B Please
at [l/O)screen
operation
of PMC.
(Note)
It is possible
to load
by memory
card
only
for FSlG-B,
FS18-B,
FS-20,
FS21-B,
and
(PMC-NB). refer to the following manual about detailed operation of loading by the memory
PMC MODEL
PROGRAMMING
MANUAL
A5-3
APPENDIX
5 TOOL
FOR CHANGING
MESSAGE
DATA (CHGMES)
5.
Check
USING EXAMPLE
the installation of this function by using the following system example. disk for checking this function.
sample
floppy
RB3DUMMY.SFM
: : : : : :
Message (Message
ladder
file (Handy
file format)
RB3BASIC.SFM
RB3MES.SFM
(Message file,
when
execute
It is possible
to check
result
by comparing
and this file.) as the following (In this case the system is installed in marn
Execute body.)
(1
Please
for OUTPUT
this example,USERTEST.SFM
(2) Following
file is generated
on current (Message
drive.
USERTEST.SFM
data (50KB))
(3) Check If NO
COMMAND).
A: M > FC/A
DIFFERENCES
6.
ERROR MESSAGES
Message Meaning (pmc type) and countermeasure between applied
chgmes
chgmes
(input file)
PMC type of input file and key in PMC type do not match.
chgmes
(compare
file)
chgmes (compare
: Message
file do size by
message
function
: Cannot
start ASC2lMG
ASC2lMG.EXE directory
of CHGMES.EXE.
A5-4
Message chgmes
: Cannol
start IMG2ASC
: Cannot : Cannot
make temporary
file
It is impossible
. It is impossible
$tmp.tOO
because
-$tmp.t99
: Cannot
(w).t
Temporary Please
file can not be closed. the dtsk space. Please free up 235KB
check
asc2img
: Cannot
allocate
memory
(bytes)
Memory
is insufficient.
and re-activate.
: Conversion
area in Input is
Ladder Please
header re-make
of the input file is crushed. the input file, and re-activate. Please change
: Unknown
file type
asc2img
No.*
has
There Please
is an invalid correct
as error message,
: Cannot : Cannot
There
is no input file. to close the file. the disk space. to write the temporary the disk space. Please free up 235KB file.
asc2img
: Cannot
wnte
Img2asc
: Cannot
allocate
memory
(bytes)
Memory
is insufficient.
: Cannot
wrote
A5-5
APPENDIX 6 MEMORY CARD COMPATIBILITY (FOR THE PMC-RAl/RA3, NB, AND QC)
APPENDIX
programmer
(see below).
Series
4080. edition
/ /
I I , I
, I
.&
,
:
,. .,
-,
II .,
: Operating
on an upgraded
: Possible
under
: Operating
on an earlier
edition
Cases
input.output
is possible
under some
condition,
are explained
below.
Cases 0) and (?! output Input : No special operatton IS required. to enter a sequence program
A6-1
APPENDIX
7 CAUTIONS
APPENDIX
7 CAUTIONS
Be
careful
especially
when
the
AUTOEXEC.BAT
contains
command
line
of
SMARTDRV.EXE.
Wwtoml
When SMARTDRV.EXE
l
enabled,
the following
symptom writer,
occurs. disabling
Alarm message
Received OVERRUN
data Invalid
[Measure] When SMARTDRV.EXE is used, disable write caching for the following disk drives:
a.
b.
system
exists
Example)
system
is on drive
file is to be
SMARTDRV
disable
write caching
for drives
A and B
Refer
to the Microsoft
Windows
3.1 Function
Guide,
supplied
from
Microsoft,
for detailed
descriptions
A7 - 1
APPENDIX
DATA TRANSFER
CABLES
APPENDIX
Use the cables
8 DATA TRANSFER
below to transfer
CABLES
ROM writer (FA writer or PMC writer),
1.
25-pin female connector IBM PC/AT cable CNC, ROM writer, or P-G
2.
or P-G
A8 - 1
APPENDIX
DATA TRANSFER
CABLES
On-line
cable
(AO8B-0031-K8OllK802)
2 SD RD 4
2 SD RD 4
RS
25-pin male connector cs ER DR CD
20
ER DR CD
7 7
SG
1 FG
1
SG FG
CD
3 RD 2 SD 20 ER 7 SG 6 6 DR 7 4 RS 8 5 cs 9 22 Cl 25-pin female connector
SG
OR RS
cs
Cl
A8-2
APPENDIX
INQUIRY
FORM
APPENDIX
Companv Person Address name in charqe
INQUIRY FORM
Section Phone Fax No. FANUC sales person No.
( (
1 )
No.
1 2 3 4
Product
name
Ordering
code
Version No.
Date of purchase
environment] type used (PC) Version Yes (printer, I No etc.) and AUTOEXEC.BAT (Manufacturer: (Manufacturer: (Manufacturer: (Manufacturer: files on a sheet and attach it to this form. 1 1 1
MS-DOS
Please
about
this product.
A9-1
OPERATORS
. 456.6
f 4.5.10
02 Apri. 96 4.6.3.2 4.6.4.7
Backup of user pro ram IS added Selecttng On-Line ? unction from Off-Line Functton IS added Selecting Off-Line Function from On-Line Function IS added Displaylng System InformatIon is added
01
Jan. 96
Edition
Date
Contents
Edition
Date
Contents
EUROPEAN
HEADQUARTERS
- GRAND-DUCHk
DE LUXEMBOURG
GE Fanuc Automation Europe S.A. Zone Industrielle L6469 Echternach 4 (+352) 727979- 1 I (+352) 727979-214 BELGIUM / NETHERLANDS GE Fanuc Automation Europe S.A. - Netherlands Branch Postbus 7230 - NL.4800 GE Breda Minervum 1603A - NL.4817 ZL Breda 4 (+31) 765783 201 (CNC) = (+31) 765783 212 (PLC) I (+31) 765870 181 FRANCE GE Fanuc Automation France S.A. 45, rue du Bois Chaland Lisses F-91 029 Evry Cedex = (+33) 1 69 89 70 39 (CNC) 4 (+33) 1 69 89 70 20 (PLC) I (+33) 1 69 89 70 49 GERMANY GE Fanuc Automation GmbH Elberfelder Str. 45 D-40724 Hilden 4 (+49) 2103 87011 (Laser/CNC) = (+49) 2103 240 415 (PLC) I (+49) 2103 87 160 (Laser/CNC) I (+49) 2103 242 153 (PLC) GERMANY GE Fanuc Automation Deutschland Bensheimer Str. 61 D-65428 Russelsheim 4 (+49) 6142 357600 I (+49) 6142 357611 GmbH CZECH REPUBLIC GE Fanuc Automation Europe S.A. c/o GETSCO Inc. Husova 5 CZ-110 00 Praha 1 = (+420) 22440 1284 I (+420) 22440 1284 GERMANY GE Fanuc Automation GmbH Bernhauser StraBe 45 D-73765 Neuhausen = (+49) 7158 187 I (+49) 7158 187 455 I (+49) 7158 187 466 a.d.F 400 (CNC) (PLC)
GERMANY GE Fanuc Automation GmbH Otto-Schmerbach-Str. 20 D-091 17 Chemnitz = (+49) 371 8448 113 (CNC) = (+49) 371 8448 114 (PLC) I (+49) 371 8448 115 SWEDEN GE Fanuc Automation Nordic AB Hammarbacken 4 S-l 9149 Sollentuna 4 (+46) 8 444 5520 I (+46) 8 444 552 1 ITALY GE Power Controls Italia S.p.a Via Tortona 27 I-201 44 Milan0 = (+39) 2 4242 280 (PLC) I (+39) 2 4242 511 (PLC) SPAIN GE Power Controls Iberica S.A. Calle Mifio, S/N E-08223 Terrassa (Barcelona) = (+34) 3 736 58 28 (PLC) I (+34) 3 783 45 82 (PLC) UNITED KINGDOM GE Fanuc Automation (UK) Ltd. Unit 1 - Mill Square Featherstone Road Wolverton Mill South Milton Keynes MK12 5BZ = (+44) 1908 84 4000 I (+44) 1908 84 4001
01/98
ITALY GE Fanuc Automation Italia S.r.1. Piazza Tirana 24/4B I-201 44 Milan0 4 (+39) 2 417 176 (CNC) I (+39) 2 419 669 (CNC) SPAIN GE Fanuc Automation Espana S.A. Poligono Industrial Olaso Calle Olaso, 57 - Locales 10 y 11 E-20870 Elgoibar = (+34) 43 744 450 (CNC) I (+34) 43 744 421 (CNC) SWITZERLAND GE Fanuc Automation Suisse/Niederlassung Schweiz MullerstraBe 3 CH-2562 Port (+41) 32 332 87 00 (CNC) (+41) 32 332 87 04 (PLC) (+41) 32 332 87 01 (CNC) (+41) 32 332 87 05 (PLC)
Filiale
4 = I I
TECHNICAL REPORT
No.TMN98/136E
Date Nov.16,1998 General Manager of Software Laboratory
GE Fanuc-E
IDE V.G.M.
Type of applied technical documents Name Spec.No./Ed. FANUC OPEN CNC LADDER EDITING PACKAGE OPERATORS MANUAL B-62884EN/01
Group
Name/Outline Working under a Command Prompt of a full screen of WindowsNT4.0 Functional instruction PSGNL and PSGN2 (Only for PMC-SB5/SB6 for Power Mate i-D/H) Ladder Printer Tool for PMC
Basic Function
Add
July.1998 or later
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
1/67
Contents
1. 2. 3.
Outline.......................................................................................................................................3 Applied Software .......................................................................................................................3 Full screen display of a Command Prompt of Windows NT4.0...................................................4 3.1 Operating Environment.......................................................................................................4 3.2 Installation ..........................................................................................................................5 4. Functional Instruction PSGNL / PSGN2.....................................................................................5 5. Ladder Printer Tool for PMC ......................................................................................................6 5.1 Outline................................................................................................................................6 5.2 Operating Environment.......................................................................................................6 5.3 The Contents of Package ...................................................................................................7 5.4 Installation and Uninstallation .............................................................................................8 5.5 Operation .........................................................................................................................14
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
2/67
1.
Outline
The following function of Ladder Editing Package has been added. Working under a Command Prompt of a full screen of WindowsNT4.0 Functional instruction PSGNL and PSGN2 (Power Mate iD/H) Ladder Printer Tool for PMC This manual is a supplementary manual for these additional functions. Other explanation (existign functions and operation,etc.) are described in the following manual. Name of Manual Spec.No. Reference Items FANUC OPEN CNC B-62884EN Operation for LADDER EDITING PACKAGE Ladder Editing Package OPERATOR'S MANUAL
2.
Applied Software
The additional functions described herein apply to the following software. Ladder Editing Package Name Specification Version Ladder Editing Package A08B-9201-J510 3.0 or later PMC Control Software(Power Mate iD/H ) Software Series PMC-SB5/SB6 control software 407B LADDER EDITING CARD 407D
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
3/67
3.
3.1 Operating Environment (Correct a part of the 2.1 Operating environment) [present] OS Microsoft Windows95 (Note1) DOS Version 5.0/V or later (to activate Japanese/ English system) DOS Version 5.0 or later (to activate English system) [correction] OS Microsoft Windows95 (Note1) Microsoft Windows NT4.0 (Note7) DOS Version 5.0/V or later (to activate Japanese/ English system) DOS Version 5.0 or later (to activate English system) (Add 7. in Notes of 2.1 Operating environment) 7. When using this software under Windows NT4.0, please note the following items. a) Please install the software after referring to 2.3.1 Registering the software in Windows [Programs] menu. b)Please install Service Pack 3 software. Please get this Service Pack3 from Microsoft Corporation. c)Please define ANSI.SYS in the CONFIG file (config.nt) for WindowsNT4.0.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
4/67
3.2 Installation (Correct a part of the 3.2 Installation) [present] 2.3.1 Registering the software in Windows95 [Programs] menu. [correction] 2.3.1 Registering the software in Windows95/NT4.0 [Programs] menu.
4.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
5/67
5.
5.1 Outline (Add after 4. Error message list) 5. Ladder Printer Tool for PMC 5.1 Outline Ladder Printer Tool for PMC is a print software of a sequence program which works under Windows95/NT4.0. This software is able to print a source program (FORMAT-C type) by various forms according to the print setting. This software also has preview function. 5.2 Operating Environment (Correct a part of the 2.1 Operating environment) [present] Printer EPSON VP1000 and compatible machines (Note6) [correction] Printer [Print (Off-line function)] EPSON VP1000 and compatible machines (Note6) [Ladder Printer Tool for PMC] Printer which can be added by [Printers] of Windows (Note8) (Add 8. in Notes of 2.1 Operating environment) 8. Ladder Printer Tool for PMC is an application software for Windows95/NT4.0. For details, refer 5. Ladder Printer Tool for PMC.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
6/67
5.3 The Contents of Package (Replace the 2.2 The Contents of Package) 2.2 The Contents of Package The Ladder Editing Package is stored in 9 floppy disks listed below. The media size is 3.5 inch 2HD (1.44MB). Please confirm contents. (1) Ladder Editing Package (Vol.1) / A08B-9201-J510#ZZ07-1 (2) Ladder Editing Package (Vol.2) / A08B-9201-J510#ZZ07-2 (3) Ladder Editing Package (Vol.3) / A08B-9201-J510#ZZ07-3 (4) Ladder Editing Package (Vol.4) / A08B-9201-J510#ZZ07-4 (5) Ladder Editing Package (Vol.5) / A08B-9201-J510#ZZ07-5 (6) Ladder Editing Package (Vol.6) / A08B-9201-J510#ZZ07-6 (Note1) (7) Ladder Editing Package (Vol.7) / A08B-9201-J510#ZZ07-7 (Note1) (8) Ladder Editing Package (Vol.8) / A08B-9201-J510#ZZ07-8 (Note1) (9) Ladder Editing Package (Vol.9) / A08B-9201-J510#ZZ07-9 (Note1) (Note1) Vol.6Vol.9 are disks for Ladder Printer Tool for PMC. Details on each disk are as follows. Vol.6 Setup disk for Japanese version Vol.7 Setup disk for English version Vol.8 Ladder Printer Tool for PMC (1) Vol.9 Ladder Printer Tool for PMC (2)
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
7/67
5.4 Installation and Uninstallation (Replace (12) in the 2.3.1 Registering the software in Windows95/NT4.0 [Programs] menu) (12) Upon the completion of installation, the Ladder Editing Package is registered in the [Programs] menu and the following screen is displayed. If you want to install continuously the Ladder Printer Tool for PMC, click [OK] button. If you dont want to install this tool, click [Cancel] button. When [Cancel] button is clicked, the installation terminates.
[Note] 1. The configuration of the directory in which the Ladder Editing Package has been installed cannot be modified. 2. When installing the Ladder Printer Tool for PMC at WindowsNT4.0, a privilege for Administrator is needed. (Add (13), (14) in the 2.3.1 Registering the software in Windows95/NT4.0 [Programs] menu) (13) When you install the Ladder Printer Tool for PMC, the following dialog is displayed. Set a specified disk and click [OK] button.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
8/67
(14) The installer of the Ladder Printer Tool for PMC starts. Please input the following items according to the instruction dialog and install this software. (a) Registration Information (Name, Company ) (b) Installation Directory (c) Program Folder Please refer to 5. Ladder Printer Tool for PMC for details.
(Add after 5.1 Outline in 5. Ladder Printer Tool for PMC) 5.2 Installation and Uninstallation Ladder Printer Tool for PMC is able to be installed from the setup disk for this software. (Vol.6 : For Japanese or Vol.7 : For English) [Note] 1. When installing the Ladder Printer Tool for PMC at WindowsNT4.0, a privilege for Administrator is needed. 5.2.1 Starting installer (1) Set the setup disk (Vol.6 : For Japanese or Vol.7 : For English) in a floppy disk drive. (this example is a case to set it in drive A.) (2) Execute Setup.exe. The installer of Ladder Printer Tool for PMC starts.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
9/67
5.2.2 Operating installation The installer of Ladder Printer Tool for PMC is basically advanced according to following procedures. 1) Installer start 2) License contract confirmation 3) User registration 4) User registration confirmation 5) Installation directory selection 6) Program folder selection 7) Installation information confirmation 8) Program copy 9) Installation completion A main operation of installation is described as follows. (1) User registration Specify your name and the company name. The number of maximum characters of the name and company name is 40 characters. If you dont input either the name or the company name, [Next] button becomes invalid. Please input both items. After input operation ends, click [Next] button. In default, the name and the company name of the user registration of Windows are displayed.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
10/67
(2) Installation directory selection Specify the installation directory. When you want to install in another directory, click [Browse] button. The directory selection screen is displayed and the installation directory can be input or can be chosen. After you specify the installation directory, click [Next] button. Default directory is (SystemDirectory)\Program Files\Ladder Printer Tool.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
11/67
(3) Program folder selection Specify the program folder. If the specified folder does not exist, new folder is created. After you specified the folder, click [Next] button. Default folder is FAPT LADDER-II.
Fig. 5.2.2.4 Program folder selection screen Please perform other operations of the installation according to the questions instructed by the installer. 5.2.3 Configuration after installation (1) Directory configuration The installer of Ladder Printer Tool for PMC automatically makes the following sub-directories under the specified directory(For example C:\PRTTOOL). C:\PRTOOL ENG (or JPN) There are files of the help and the resource, etc. in this sub-directory. [Note] Dont delete the above-mentioned directory except uninstallation of this tool.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
12/67
(2) Dynamic Link Library (DLL) files Most of system files of Ladder Printer Tool for PMC are installed in the specified directory. But the following DLL files are installed in the system directory of Windows (For example : C:\Winnt40\system32). a) Mfc40.dll b) Msvcrt40.dll [Note] Dont delete the above-mentioned files except uninstallation of this tool. (3) Program Folder and Shortcut When installing this tool, the following program folder and shortcut are made. The program folder name is specified by the installation of this tool. (Default name : FAPT LADDER-II) Two shortcuts are made as follows. a) [Ladder Printer Tool for PMC] This is a shortcut for starting Ladder Printer Tool for PMC. b) [Uninstall Ladder Printer Tool for PMC] (Note1) This is a shortcut for uninstallation of Ladder Printer Tool for PMC. [Note] 1. This shortcut is made only when installing at WindowsNT4.0. (4) Registry When installing Ladder Printer Tool for PMC, the information of this tool is written in the registry of Windows. 5.2.4 Uninstallation This tool has the function of uninstallation. When you execute the uninstaller, the files, the folder, the registry, and the program folder, etc. made by the installer are deleted. Uninstaller is started according to the following procedures. (1) Common operations of WindowsNT4.0 and Windows95 1)Select [Ladder Printer Tool for PMC] on Add/Remove Program Properties of the control panel. And click [Add/Remove] button. 2)After a confirmation dialog box is displayed, click [Yes] button. The uninstaller starts. (2) Only operations of WindowsNT4.0 Another operation to start the uninstaller is to select [Uninstall Ladder Printer Tool for PMC] on the program folder.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
13/67
5.5 Operation (Add after 5.2 Installation and uninstallation in 5. Ladder Printer Tool for PMC) 5.3 Operation 5.3.1 Start Ladder Printer Tool for PMC starts when selecting PMCLDPRT.exe in the directory at which the this tool is installed with the Explorer etc., or selecting the shortcut of this tool. And an initial menu is displayed. 5.3.2 Termination To terminate Ladder Printer Tool for PMC, click the close button of the application window, or select the [Close] of the control menu, or select the [Exit] of the File menu on the initial menu or the program opening menu. 5.3.3 Menu configuration The configuration of menu, which this tool displays, is as follows. (1) Initial menu
File Open Program
Version
Menu
configuration
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
14/67
View
Version
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
15/67
5.3.4 Example of basic operation when printing The following example shows a basic operation of Ladder Printer Tool for PMC from the beginning to print Title Data and Ladder Diagram of program name RB4_SFC. [Operation] (1) Start of Ladder Printer Tool for PMC Ladder Printer Tool for PMC starts when selecting PMCLDPRT.exe in the directory at which the this tool is installed with the Explorer and etc., or selecting the shortcut of this tool. And an initial menu is displayed.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
16/67
(2) Open the file (Selecting the program) 1) Select [Open Program] of the [File] menu.
Fig. 5.3.4.2 [File] menu screen 2) Specify the program name on the file dialog which is displayed. After inputting the program name which you want to open (a program name which you want to print) or selecting the folder of the program which you want to open (a program which you want to print) on the following screen, click [Open] button. If you select a folder (directory) of a sequence program, the program is automatically opened. In this case, the folder of "RB4_SFC is selected.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
17/67
Fig. 5.3.4.4 Program-opening screen (3) Print 1) Click [Print] button of the print preview toolbar displayed in the upper part of the program-opening screen.
[Print] button
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
18/67
2) When clicking [Print] button, the print dialog is displayed. Click [Option] button when you want to set print options. Click [Printer] button when you want to set printer items. Refer to 5.3.8 Print screen or 5.3.9 Printer set screen for details.
Fig
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
19/67
3) Choose items which you want to print. In this case, click [Select] button of Print Data group, first, then choose Title Data and Ladder Diagram which are to be printed.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
20/67
4) Erase the check marks other than Title Data and Ladder Diagram.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
21/67
5) When clicking [OK] button, the print starts. When you want to discontinue while printing, click [Cancel] button of the printing screen.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
22/67
5.3.5 Initial menu The initial menu is a menu displayed in the state immediately after the start of Ladder Printer Tool for PMC or in the state without any program specified. There are three menus of [File], [View], and [Help] in the initial menu. Select [File] to open the program. Select [View] to switch to show and hide toolbar or status bar. Select [Help] to refer to help and version information. Before specifying any program in the initial menu, [Print] button of toolbar becomes invalid and cannot be clicked. Refer to 5.3.10 Toolbar for details of toolbar.
Fig. 5.3.5 Initial menu screen 5.3.5.1 File The [File] menu has menus for specifying print program and for terminating Ladder Printer Tool for PMC.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
23/67
(1) Open Program Open a printing program. The file dialog is displayed as a screen where the program name is selected.
Fig. 5.3.5.1 Program selection screen Specify the program name on the file dialog which is displayed. After inputting a program name which you want to print, click [Open] button. Click [Cancel] button to discontinue opening the program. (2) Exit Exits Ladder Printer Tool for PMC.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
24/67
5.3.5.2 View [View] menu is a menu related to the display of toolbar and status bar. Select [Tool Bar] to switch to show and hide toolbar. Select [Status Bar] to switch to show and hide status bar.
Fig. 5.3.5.2 [View] menu screen (1) Tool Bar Switch to show or hide the toolbar. Toolbar includes buttons for some of most common commands in Ladder Printer Tool for PMC. A check mark appears next to the menu item when the toolbar is shown. Refer to 5.3.10 Toolbar for details of toolbar. (2) Status Bar Switch to show or hide the status bar. Status bar describes the action to be executed by the selected menu item or depressed toolbar button, and keyboard Latch State. A check mark appears next to the menu item when the status bar is shown. Refer to 5.3.11 Status Bar for details of status bar.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
25/67
5.3.5.3 Help [Help] menu is a menu related to help and version information. Select [Topic] to refer to help and to retrieve the topic. Select [Version] to refer to version information.
Fig. 5.3.5.3(a) [Help] menu screen (1) Topic Use this command to display the opening screen of Help. An index to topics, on which you can get help, is offered to you. From the opening screen, you can jump to step-bystep instructions for using Ladder Printer Tool for PMC and to various types of reference information. Once you open Help, you can click the Contents button whenever you want to return to the opening screen.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
26/67
Fig. 5.3.5.3(b) Help Topics screen (2) Version The version number of this application is displayed. The copyright notice and version number of your copy of Ladder Printer Tool for PMC is displayed. When returning to the menu screen, click [OK] button.
Fig. 5.3.5.3(c) Version information screen 5.3.6 Program Opening Menu Program Opening Menu is a menu in the state that the program is selected. There are
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
27/67
three menus of [File], [View], and [Help] in Program Opening Menu. Select [File] to operate functions related to files and printing. Select [View] to switch to show and hide toolbar or status bar. Select [Help] to refer to the help and version information. When specifying the program, [Print] button from the toolbar can be clicked. Refer to 5.3.10 Toolbar for details of toolbar.
5.3.6.1 File [File] menu is a menu to operate functions related to files and printing. Select [Open Program] to open an existing program. Select [Close Program] to close the program which is opened now. Select [Print] to print and to set the print option data. Select [Preview] to display the document on the screen as it would appear on the printed document. Select [Printer] to select a printer and printer connection setting.
Fig. 5.3.6.1 [File] menu screen (Program opening) (1) Open Program
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
28/67
Close a program which is opened now and open a new program. File dialog is displayed as a screen where the program name is specified. Refer to (1) Open Program in 5.3.5.1 File for details. (2) Close Program Close a program, which is opened now. After closing the program, the menu becomes an initial menu. (3) Print The sequence program is printed, and the option of the print item is set, and the printer is set. Print dialog screen is opened. Refer to 5.3.8 Print screen for details. (4) Preview Displays the document on the screen as it would appear on printed document. The main window will be replaced with a print preview window in which one or two pages will be displayed in their printed format. Refer to 5.3.7 Preview screen for details of preview. (5) Printer Selects a printer and set various items. Print setting dialog is displayed. Refer to 5.3.9 Printer set screen for details. (6) Exit Exits Ladder Printer Tool for PMC.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
29/67
5.3.6.2 View [View] menu is a menu related to the display of toolbar and the display of status bar. Select Tool Bar to switch display and hide of toolbar. Select Status Bar to switch display and hide of status bar. (1) Tool Bar Switch to show or hide the toolbar. Toolbar includes buttons for some of most common commands in Ladder Printer Tool for PMC. A check mark appears next to the menu item when the toolbar is shown. Refer to 5.3.10 Toolbar for details of toolbar. (2) Status Bar Switch to show or hide the status bar. Status bar describes the action to be executed by the selected menu item or depressed toolbar button, and keyboard Latch State. A check mark appears next to the menu item when the status bar is shown. Refer to 5.3.11 Status Bar for details of status bar. 5.3.6.3 Help [Help] menu is a menu related to the help and version information. Select [Help] to refer to the help. Select [Version] to refer to version information.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
30/67
(1) Help Offers you a help of Ladder Printer Tool for PMC. From the opening screen, you can jump to step-by-step instructions for using Ladder Printer Tool for PMC and various types of reference information. Once you open Help, you can click the Contents button whenever you want to return to the opening screen.
Fig. 5.3.6.3(b) Help screen (2) Version The version number of this application is displayed. The copyright notice and version number of your copy of Ladder Printer Tool for PMC is displayed. When returning to the menu screen, click [OK] button.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
31/67
5.3.7 Preview Screen (Program opening screen) When selecting [Preview], the preview screen is displayed. When opening the program specified with [Program Open], [Title] preview of the program is displayed. The preview toolbar offers you options to view either one or two pages at a time; to move back and forth through the document; to zoom in and out of pages; and to initiate a print job. When selecting [Title] and [Ladder] and etc. button of the print item on toolbar, the Preview screen corresponding to the button is displayed. The print item not selected by print dialog cannot preview, and the print item which dose not correspond by PMC model cannot be previewed.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
32/67
Details of each button are as follows. Tool Operation Bring up the print dialog box, to start a print job. Preview the previous printed page. Preview the next printed page. Preview one or two printed pages at a time. Zoom in the printed page. Zoom out the printed page. Return from print preview to the editing window. Display Preview of Title Data. Display Preview of System Parameter. Display Preview of Symbol Comment. Display Preview of Ladder Diagram. Display Preview of Step Sequence Diagram. Display Preview of I/O Module Data. Display Preview of Message Data. Display Preview of Cross Reference. Display Preview of Bit Address Map.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
33/67
5.3.8 Print Screen The sequence program is printed. Moreover, the print option and the printer is set. 5.3.8.1 Print setting Select and print the item that you want to print in this dialog. Moreover, the print option setting dialog and the printer setting dialog can be called.
Fig. 5.3.8.1 Print dialog Details of each item are as follows. [Program Name] Group Display the program name, which is opened now. [Print Data] Group [ALL] [Select] Choose the item, which you want to print. In default, [ALL] is checked. Specify to print all data. Specify the print data. The print item can be selected by checking [Select]. The checked print item is printed. The print item do not correspond by the PMC model is not displayed.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
34/67
Begins the print. Discontinue printing. Set the option concerning the print data. When this button is selected, the print option set dialog is displayed. Do the printer setting and the print setting. When this button is selected, the printer set dialog is displayed.
5.3.8.2 Title Data print Set the option of the Title Data print.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
35/67
Details of each item are as follows. [Start Page No.] Group Set page number. [Page No.] Set beginning page numbers of the Title Data print. The integer value can be set. In default, 1 is set. [Print Title] Group [Title] [Sub Title] [Preview] Button [OK] Button [Cancel] Button [Help] Button Specify the title and the sub title printed when the frame print is specified. A title and a sub title can be specified up to 60 characters. Specify the title of the Title Data print. In default, Title Data is set. Specify the title of the Title Data print. The character string is not set in default. Save the print option setting and do preview of the Title Data print. This button is effective when any print item is selected. Save the print option setting and end the print option set dialog. Discontinue the print option setting and end the print option set dialog. Refer to help of the Title Data print option.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
36/67
5.3.8.3 System Parameter print Set the option of the System Parameter print.
Fig. 5.3.8.3 System Parameter print option screen Details of each item are as follows. [Start Page No.] Group Set page number. [Page No.] Set beginning page numbers of the System Parameter print. The integer value can be set. In default, 1 is set. [Print Title] Group [Title] [Sub Title] Specify the title and the sub title printed when the frame print is specified. A title and a sub title can be specified up to 60 characters. Specify the title of the System Parameter print. In default, System Parameter is set. Specify the title of the System Parameter print. Any character string is not set in default.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
37/67
Save the print option setting and do preview of the System Parameter print. This button is effective when any print item is selected. Save the print option setting and end the print option setting dialog. Discontinue the print option setting and end the print option setting dialog. Refer to help of the System Parameter print option.
5.3.8.4 Symbol & Comment print Set the option of the Symbol & Comment print.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
38/67
Details of each item are as follows. [Start Page No.] Group Set page number. [Page No.] Set beginning page numbers of the Symbol & Comment print. The integer value can be set. In default, 1 is set. [Print Title] Group [Title] [Sub Title] [Page Range] Group [All] [Line No.] [Page No.] [Comment] Group Specify the title and the sub title printed when the frame print is specified. A title and a sub title can be specified up to 60 characters. Specify the title of the Symbol & Comment print. In default, Symbol & Comment is set. Specify the title of the Symbol & Comment print. Any character string is not set in default. Set the range of the print. In default, [All] is checked. All are printed. Specify the range of the line number, which you want to print. Specify the range of the page number, which you want to print.
Select the kind of comment. In default, [Relay Comment] is checked. [Relay Comment] Specify to print only the relay comment. [Coil Comment] Specify to print only the coil comment. [Relay Comment/Coil Comment] Specify to print both the relay comment and the coil comment. Save the print option setting and do preview of the Symbol & Comment print. This button is effective when any print item is selected. Save the print option setting and end the print option set dialog. Discontinue the print option setting and end the print option set dialog. Refer to help of the Symbol & Comment print option.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
39/67
5.3.8.5 Ladder Diagram print Set the option of the Ladder Diagram print. (1) Ladder Diagram print option screen
Fig. 5.3.8.5(a) Ladder Diagram print option screen Details of each item are as follows. [Start Page No.] Group Set page number. [Page No.] Set beginning page numbers of the Ladder Diagram to be printed. An integer value can be set. In default, 1 is set. [Print Title] Group [Title] [Sub Title] [Print Range] Group [All] [Net No.] [Page No.] Specify the title and the sub title printed when the frame print is specified. A title and a sub title can be specified up to 60 characters. Specify the title of the Ladder Diagram print. In default, Ladder Diagram is set. Specify the title printed with the Ladder Diagram. Any character string is not set in default. Set the range of the print. In default, [All] is checked. All are printed. Specify the range of the net, which you want to print. Specify the range of the page, which you want to print.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
40/67
Set printing Ladder Program. In default, [All] is checked. All are printed. Print specified subprogram. Input the subprogram name which you want to print, or select the subprogram name from combo box. Specify the data printed for each contact. In default, [Symbol] is checked. Print the symbol data of contact. Print the relay comment data of contact. Specify the presence of form feed for each subprogram. Default is no form feed. Specify the presence of cross reference. Default is no cross reference. Specify a detailed setting of the Ladder Diagram print. The Ladder Diagram detailed setting dialog is displayed when selecting. Refer to 2 Ladder Diagram print option detailed screen for details. Save the print option setting and do preview of the Ladder Diagram. This button is effective when any print item is selected. Save the print option setting and end the print option setting dialog. Discontinue the print option setting and end the print option setting dialog. Refer to help of the Ladder Diagram print option.
[Relay/Coil] Group [Symbol] [Relay Comment] [Page Feed(Sub Program)] [Cross Reference] [Details] Button
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
41/67
Fig. 5.3.8.5(b) Ladder Diagram print option detailed screen Details of each item are as follows. [Step No.] Specify the presence of the step number. Default is checked. [Net No.] Specify the presence of the net number. Default is checked. [Line] Group [Narrow] [Wide] Specify the space between lines in the net. In default, [Narrow] is checked. Print the lines of the net with narrow space. Print the lines of the net with wide space.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
42/67
5.3.8.6 Step Sequence Diagram print Set the option of the Step Sequence Diagram print. As for the PMC model which doesnt correspond to the step sequence, this page is not displayed. Moreover, the PMC model that corresponds to the step sequence is not displayed if there is no step sequence file either.
Fig. 5.3.8.6 Step Sequence Diagram print option screen Details of each item are as follows. [Start Page No.] Group Set page number. [Page No.] Set beginning page numbers of the Step Sequence Diagram print. An integer value can be set. In default, 1 is set.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
43/67
[Print Title] Group [Title] [Sub Title] [Print Program] Group [All] [Unit] [Sub Program No.] [Preview] Button [OK] Button [Cancel] Button [Help] Button
Specify the title and the sub title printed when the frame print is specified. A title and a sub title can be specified up to 60 characters. Specify the title of the Step Sequence Diagram print. In default, Step Sequence Diagram is set. Specify the title of the Step Sequence Diagram print. Any character string is not set in default. Select Step Sequence Program to be printed. In default, [All] is checked. All are printed. Print selected subprogram. Input the subprogram name, which you want to print or select the subprogram name from combo box. Specify the presence of the print of the sub program number. Default is checked. Save the print option setting and do preview of the Step Sequence Diagram print. This button is effective when any print item is selected. Save the print option setting and end the print option set dialog. Discontinue the print option setting and end the print option set dialog. Refer to help of the Step Sequence Diagram print option.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
44/67
5.3.8.7 I/O Module Data print Set the option of the I/O Module Data print.
Fig. 5.3.8.7 I/O Module Data print option screen Details of each item are as follows. [Start Page No.] Group Set page number. [Page No.] Set beginning page numbers of the I/O Module Data. An integer value can be set. In default, 1 is set. [Print Title] Group [Title] [Sub Title] Specify the title and the sub title printed when the frame print is specified. A title and a sub title can be specified up to 60 characters. Specify the title of the I/O Module Data. In default, I/O Module is set. Specify the title of the I/O Module Data. Any character string is not set in default.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
45/67
[Print Channel] Group [1 Channel] [2 Channel] [Preview] Button [OK] Button [Cancel] Button [Help] Button
Specify the print channel. Only when the PMC model is PMC-QC, it is possible to set this item. This group is not displayed for another model. Print the first channel. Default is checked. Print the second channel. Default is checked. Save the print option setting and do preview of the I/O Module Data print. This button is effective when any print item is selected. Save the print option setting and end the print option set dialog. Discontinue the print option setting and end the print option set dialog. Refer to help of the I/O Module Data print option.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
46/67
5.3.8.8 Message Data print Set the option of the Message Data print. When the PMC model is PMC-QC, this page is not displayed because there is no message file.
Fig. 5.3.8.8(a) Message Data print option screen Details of each item are as follows. [Start Page No.] Group Set page number. [Page No.] Set beginning page numbers of the Message Data. An integer value can be set. In default, 1 is set. [Print Title] Group [Title] [Sub Title] Specify the title and the sub title printed when the frame print is specified. A title and a sub title can be specified up to 60 characters. Specify the title of the Message Data. In default, Message is set. Specify the title of the Message Data. Any character string is not set in default.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
47/67
[Print Range] Group [All] [Address] [Page No.] [Preview] Button [OK] Button [Cancel] Button [Help] Button
Set the range of the print. In default, [All] is checked. All are printed. Specify the range of the address, which you want to print. Refer to Table 5.3.8.8(b) for the specification of range. Specify the range of the page, which you want to print. Save the print option setting and do preview of the Message Data print. This button is effective when any print item is selected. Save the print option setting and end the print option setting dialog. Discontinue the print option setting and end the print option setting dialog. Refer to help of the Message Data print option.
Table 5.3.8.8(b) Specification of address of Message Data Address specification Example of key Output address Kind input Bit Address A5.0 Only the specified bit address Byte Address A4 Specified Byte Address and Bit Address in a range of 0-7. Address range A2.3-A5.7 All addresses within the specified Specification Range
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
48/67
5.3.8.9 Cross Reference print Set the option of the Cross Reference print. (1) Cross Reference print option screen
Fig. 5.3.8.9(a) Cross Reference print option screen Details of each item are as follows. [Start Page No.] Group Set page number. [Page No.] Set beginning page numbers of the Cross Reference. An integer value can be set. In default, 1 is set.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
49/67
[Print Title] Group [Title] [Sub Title] [Print Range] Group [All] [Address] [Address Kind] [Comment] Group [Relay Comment] [Coil Comment] [Double Check]
Specify the title and the sub title printed when the frame print is specified. A title and a sub title can be specified up to 60 characters. Specify the title of the Cross Reference print. In default, Cross Reference is set. Specify the title of the Cross Reference print. Any character string is not set in default. Set the range of the print. In default, [All] is checked. All are printed. Specify the range of the address, which you want to print. Refer to Table 5.3.8.9(b) for the specification of range. Specify the kind of the address, which you want to print. The plural items can be specified. Specify the printed comment. In default, [Relay Comment] is checked. Print the relay comment. Print the coil comment. Specify whether the checking of writing the coil doubly and the double use of the function instruction is executed. Default is not checked. Specify a detailed setting for the Cross Reference. The Cross Reference print detailed setting dialog is displayed when selecting. Refer to (2) Cross Reference print option detailed screen for details. Save the print option setting and preview the Cross Reference. This button is effective when any print item is selected. Save the print option setting and end the print option set dialog. Discontinue the print option setting and end the print option set dialog. Refer to help of the Cross Reference print option.
[Details] Button
Table 5.3.8.9(b) Specification of address of Cross Reference print table Address specification Example of key Output address Kind input Bit Address R1.0 Only the specified bit address Byte Address X10 Specified byte address (Contain the bit address)
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
50/67
F10.0-F12.7 F10.5-F10
All addresses within the specified range To the specified byte address from the specified bit address
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
51/67
Details of each item are as follows. [Print Guidance] Group Set a guidance/sub guidance of the output form. The guidance/sub guidance can be specified up to 19 characters. [Guidance] Set a guidance of the output form. In default, STEP NO./NET NO. is set. [Sub Guidance] Set a sub guidance of the output form. Any character string is not set in default. [Print Information] Group [Step No.] [Net No.] [Print No. Type] [Coil Guidance] Group Set the printed step/net number. Print the step number. Specify it the step number is printed and the first character. [Step No.] is checked in default and [Top Char] is S. Print the net number. Specify it the net number is printed and the first character. [Net No.] is checked in default and [Top Char] is N. Set the number print form. In default, Step No./Net No. is set.
Set the coil guidance. In default, [Ladder Diagram Graphics] is checked. [Ladder Diagram Graphics] Print by the graphic same as the ladder diagram. [User Define String] Print by the character string, which the user defined. The following four can be defined, when [User Define String] is selected. Four all can be specified up to 13 characters. [Read] Specify the character string to indicate the reference by Read contact. In default, Read is set. [Write] Specify the character string to indicate the reference by Write contact. In default, Write is set. [Set] Specify the character string to indicate the reference by Set contact. In default, Set is set. [Reset] Specify the character string to indicate the reference by Reset contact. In default, Reset is set.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
52/67
Specify the number of line feed inserted between the addresses. A value of 0-9 can be specified. In default, 1 is set. Specify if a form feed is inserted between different kinds of address. Default is checked.
[Page Feed]
5.3.8.10 Bit Address Map print Set the option of the Bit Address Map. (1) Bit Address Map print option screen
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
53/67
Details of each item are as follows. [Start Page No.] Group Set page number. [Page No.] Set beginning page numbers of the Bit Address Map print. An integer value can be set. In default, 1 is set. [Print Title] Group [Title] [Sub Title] [Print Range] Group [All] [Address] [Address Kind] [Using Address] [Details] Button Specify the title and the sub title printed when the frame print is specified. A title and a sub title can be specified up to 60 characters. Specify the title of the Bit Address Map print. In default, Bit Address Map is set. Specify the title of the Bit Address Map print. Any character string is not set in default. Set the range of the print. In default, [All] is checked. All are printed. Specify the range of the address, which you want to print. Refer to Table 5.3.8.10(b) for the specification of range. Specify the kind of the address, which you want to print. The plural items can be specified. Print only the address used. Default is checked. Specify a detailed setting of the Bit Address Map print. The Bit Address Map print detailed set dialog is displayed when selecting. Refer to 2 Bit Address Map print option detailed screen for details. Save the print option setting and preview the Bit Address Map print. This button is effective when any print item is selected. Save the print option setting and end the print option set dialog. Discontinue the print option setting and end the print option set dialog. Refer to help of the Bit Address Map print option.
[Preview] Button
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
54/67
Table 5.3.8.10(b) Specification of address of Bit Address Map print table Address specification Example of key Output address Kind input Bit Address R1.0 Only the specified bit address Byte Address X10 Specified byte address (Contain the bit address) Address F10.0-F12.7 All addresses within Range specification the specified range F10-F20 All addresses within the specified range (2) Bit Address Map print option detailed screen
Fig, 5.3.8.10(c) Bit Address Map print option detailed screen Details of each item are as follows. [Page Feed] Specify if a form feed is inserted between different kinds of the addresses. Default is checked. [Use Address Mark] An arbitrary sign can be set in the used address mark. Specify one character. In default, @ is set.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
55/67
Fig. 5.3.8.11 Common Item option set screen Details of each item are as follows. [Guidance Message Language] Group Specify the guide message language when the title and the system parameter are printed. [First Language] is checked in default and [First Language](combo box) is English. [First Language] Print in the language selected in the first language. [First/Second Language] Print in the languages selected in the First language and the Second language. [First Language] (combo box) Specify the first language. In default, "English is set. [Second Language] (combo box) Specify the second language. When [First/Second Language] is selected, it is possible to specify. In default, "English is set. [Print] Group Specify the cover page print. In default, [Cover] is not checked. [Cover] Specify the presence of the cover page. A file can be specified when this item is checked. The file can be selected with the File button. The format of the cover
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
56/67
page file which can be selected is a metafile. [OK] Button [Cancel] Button [Help] Button Save the print option setting and end the print option set dialog. Discontinue the print option setting and end the print option set dialog. Refer to help of the Common Item.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
57/67
5.3.9 Printer set screen 5.3.9.1 Printer setting Set the printer.
Fig. 5.3.9.1 Printer set screen Details of each item are as follows. [Printer] Group The printer setting and display information. [Name] Set the printer used. Choose the Default Printer; or choose the Specific Printer option and select one of the current installed printers shown in the box. You install printers and configure ports using the Windows Control Panel. [Cond] Display the state of the selected printer. [Kind] Display the kind of the selected printer. [Spot] Display the place of the selected printer. [Cmnt] Display additional information on the selected printer. [OK] Button [Cancel] Button [Page] Button Save the printer setting and end printer dialog. Discontinue the printer setting and end printer dialog. Display print setting Dialog to set the number of lines per one form the margin, etc.. Refer to 5.3.9.2 - 5.3.9.6 for details.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
58/67
5.3.9.2 Line Count Set the line count, and point of character/line, and font which can be printed on one page, when printing other than the Ladder Diagram and Step Sequence Diagram.
Fig. 5.3.9.2 Line Count set screen Details of each item are as follows. [Line Count] Specify the maximum number of lines, which can be printed on one page. Line Point and Font Size might be automatically adjusted according to Line Count. In default, 72 is set. [Char Point] Set the width of the character by point. Font Size might be automatically adjusted according to Char Point. In default, 10 is set. [Line Point] Set the height of one line by point. Line Count and Font Size might be automatically adjusted according to Line Point. In default, 10 is set. [Font] Group [Font Face] [Font Size] Specify font. Set the font face. In default, System is set. Set the font size. Line Count, Char Point and Line Point might be automatically adjusted according to Font Size. In default, 10 is set.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
59/67
Reset all the items of Line Count page to the default. Save the print setting and end the print setting dialog. Discontinue the print setting and end the print setting dialog. Display the help of Line Count.
5.3.9.3 Line Count (Ladder) Set the line count printed on one page, and point of character/line, and font etc., when the Ladder Diagram and the Step Sequence Diagram is printed.
Fig. 5.3.9.3 Line Count (Ladder) set screen Details of each item are as follows. [Line Count] Specify the maximum number of lines, which can be printed on one page. Line Point and Font Size might be automatically adjusted according to Line Count. In default, 78 is set. [Char Point] Set the width of the character by point. Font Size might be automatically adjusted according to Char Point. In default, 9 is set.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
60/67
[Line Point]
Set the height of one line by point. Line Count and Font Size might be automatically adjusted according to Line Point. In default, 9 is set. Specify font. Select Ladder Data for which the Font is set. Set the font face with which selected [Ladder Data] is printed. The all default is System. Set the font size with which selected [Ladder Data] is printed. Line Count, Char Point and Line Point might be automatically adjusted according to Font Size. The all default is 9. Reset all the items of Line Count(Ladder) page to the default. Save the print setting and end the print setting dialog. Discontinue the print setting and end the print setting dialog. Display the help of Line Count(Ladder).
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
61/67
5.3.9.4 Margin Set margin at the top, bottom, right and left in the print page.
Fig. 5.3.9.4 Margin set screen Details of each item are as follows. [Upper] Set an upper margin. The unit is a millimeter (mm). In default, 20 is set. [Under] Set an under margin. The unit is a millimeter (mm). In default, 10 is set. [Right] Set a right margin. The unit is a millimeter (mm). In default, 10 is set. [Left] Set a left margin. The unit is a millimeter (mm). In default, 10 is set. [OK] Button [Cancel] Button [Help] Button Save the print setting and end the print setting dialog. Discontinue the print setting and end the print setting dialog. Display the help of Margin.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
62/67
Fig. 5.3.9.5 Paper Size set screen Details of each item are as follows. [Size] Set the size of the form. In default, A4 is set. [OK] Button [Cancel] Button [Help] Button Save the print setting and end the print setting dialog. Discontinue the print setting and end the print setting dialog. Display the help of Paper Size.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
63/67
5.3.9.6 Print Type Set various items concerning the frame added to the print page.
Fig. 5.3.9.6 Print Type set screen Details of each item are as follows. [Frame Print] Group Set the presence of the frame and the character string printed. If [Frame Print] is not checked, the following setting cannot be done. [File] Specify the metafile name used when the frame is printed. The file name can be selected with the File button. [Data] Specify the data for which the character string, coordinates, and font are set.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
64/67
[String]
[X Pos]
[Y Pos]
[Font] Group [Font Face] [Font Size] [OK] Button [Cancel] Button [Help] Button
Specify the printed character string set with [Data]. The data specification by the following forms is also possible. %[T]: Print the title data. %[S]: Print the sub title data. %[P]: Print the program name. %[N]: Print page number. Default is as follows. String Data 1: %[P] String Data 2: %[T] String Data 3: %[N] String Data 4: %[S] String Data 5 is not set. Specify the print beginning position (X coordinates) of the character string set with [Data]. The unit is a millimeter (mm). Default is as follows. String Data 1: 10 String Data 2: 75 String Data 3: 180 String Data 4: 75 String Data 5: 0 Specify the print beginning position (Y coordinates) of the character string set with [Data]. The unit is a millimeter (mm). Default is as follows. String Data 1: 10 String Data 2: 10 String Data 3: 10 String Data 4: 15 String Data 5: 0 Specify the font set with [Data]. Specify the font face set with [Data]. The all default is System. Specify the font size set with [Data]. The all default is 12. Save the print setting and end the print setting dialog. Discontinue the print setting and end the print setting dialog. Display the help of Print type.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
65/67
5.3.10 Toolbar The toolbar is displayed below the menu bar at the top of the application window. The toolbar provides quick mouse access to many tools used in Ladder Printer Tool for PMC. To hide or display the Toolbar, choose Toolbar from the View menu.
Fig. 5.3.10 Toolbar Details of each button are as follows. Tool Operation Open an existing document. Ladder Printer Tool for PMC displays the open dialog box, in which you can locate and open the desired file. It is a shortcut to 5.3.5.1 (1)Program Open and 5.3.6.1 (1)Program Open. Open the print dialog. It is a shortcut to 5.3.6.1 (3)Print. However, this button is invalid and cannot be selected by an initial menu because the program is not selected. Display the copyright notice and version number of your copy of Ladder Printer Tool for PMC. It is a shortcut to 5.3.5.3 (2)Version and 5.3.6.3 (2)Version. Use the Context Help command to obtain help on some portion of Ladder Printer Tool for PMC. When you choose the Toolbar's Context Help button, the mouse pointer will change to an arrow and question mark. Then click somewhere in the Ladder Printer Tool for PMC window, such as another Toolbar button. The Help topic will be shown for the item you clicked.
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
66/67
5.3.11 Status Bar The status bar is displayed at the bottom of the Ladder Printer Tool for PMC window. To display or hide the status bar, use the Status Bar command in the View menu. The left area of the status bar describes actions of menu items as you use the arrow keys to navigate through menus. This area similarly shows messages that describe the actions of toolbar buttons as you depress them, before releasing them. If after viewing the description of the toolbar button command you wish not to execute the command, then release the mouse button while the pointer is off the toolbar button. The center area of the status bar displayed the program name and the PMC model name. The right area of the status bar displayed the state of ON/OFF of a special key. Pane1 Simple help Pane2 Program name Pane3 PMC model Pane4 State of key : Latched down is displayed [Scroll Lock] Key, [NUM Lock] Key, and [Caps Lock] Key from the right Simple help Program name PMC model Fig. 5.3.11 Status Bar State of key
TITLE
01
EDIT
98.11.13
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-62884EN/01-4
SHEET
CUST.
67/67
TECHNICAL REPORT
No. TMN99/30E
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
1/26
Type of applied technical documents Name FAPT LADDER-II OPERATORS MANUAL Spec.No./Ed. B-66184EN/02
Summary of Change New, Add, Correct, Delete Add Applicable Date Feb. 1999 or later
Group Basic Function Optional Function Unit Maintenanc e Parts Notice Correction Another
Name/Outline Programming PMC-NB6 Saving and restoring the print options Changing the print option set screens
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
2/26
Contents
1. 2. 3.
Outline.......................................................................................................................................4 Applied Software .......................................................................................................................4 Programming PMC-NB6 ............................................................................................................5 3.1 Supported PMC models .....................................................................................................5 3.2 System parameters ............................................................................................................6 4. Saving and restoring the options on the Ladder Printer Tool for PMC........................................8 4.1 Changing Menu configuration.............................................................................................8 4.2 Initial menu.......................................................................................................................10 4.3 Program opening menu ....................................................................................................12 5. Print option setting screen on the Ladder Printer Tool for PMC ...............................................13 5.1 Ladder Diagram print........................................................................................................13 5.2 Cross Reference print.......................................................................................................16 5.3 Bit Address Map print .......................................................................................................20 6. Operating environment ............................................................................................................22 7. Available characters in symbol ................................................................................................24 8. Config file ................................................................................................................................25
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
3/26
1.
Outline
The following function of FAPT LADDER-II has been added. - Programming PMC-NB6 - Saving and restoring the print options - Changing the print option set screens This manual is a supplementary manual for these additional functions. Other explanation (existign functions and operation,etc.) are described in the following manual. Name of Manual Spec.No. Reference Items FAPT LADDER-II BOperation for OPERATOR'S MANUAL 66184EN FAPT LADDER-II
2.
Applied Software
The additional functions described herein apply to the following software. FAPT LADDER-II Name Specification Version FAPT LADDER-II A08B-9201-J503 3.2 or later PMC Control Software (for Series 15i ) Software PMC-NB6 control software Series 404A Version 01 or later
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
4/26
3.
Programming PMC-NB6
3.1 Supported PMC models (Correct a part of the For PMC models table of 1.1 Overview) [present] Abbreviations PMC Models PMC-SA1 FANUC PMC-MODEL SA1 PMC-SA3 FANUC PMC-MODEL SA3 .... .... PMC-NB FANUC PMC-MODEL NB PMC-NB2 FANUC PMC-MODEL NB2 [correction]
Abbreviations PMC-SA1 PMC-SA3 .... .... PMC-NB PMC-NB2 PMC-NB6 FANUC PMC-MODEL NB FANUC PMC-MODEL NB2 FANUC PMC-MODEL NB6 PMC Models FANUC PMC-MODEL SA1 FANUC PMC-MODEL SA3
(Correct a part of the 1.2.2 PMC models to be supported) [present] PMC-SA1 PMC-SA3 (Note1) .... .... PMC-NB2 PMC-PA3 PMC-QC (Note1) [correction] PMC-SA1 PMC-SA3 .... .... PMC-NB2 PMC-NB6 PMC-PA3 PMC-QC (Note1)
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
5/26
3.2 System parameters (Add after the (ii) PMC-SC3/SC4/QC/NB/NB2 of 4.5.2.6 (4)System parameter editing screen and input item for each PMC model) (iv) PMC-NB6
Fig. 4.5.2.6(c)
Refer to the PMC PROGRAMMING MANUAL(B-61863E) about setting value of Each System parameters.
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
6/26
(Add after the PMC-QC/NB/NB2 of 4.5.8.4 Sample mnemonic files (Single-Format) (a)Parameter) PMC-NB6
2. Counter data type (BINARY or BCD) 3. Whether an operators panel is used (YES: Used, NO: Not used) 4. PMC model (PMC-NB6) 7. Ladder execution time (1% to 150%)
Note When specifying YES in Item 3 above (whether an operators panel is used), specify the KEY address, LED address, KEY image address, and LED image address as follows:
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
7/26
4.
Saving and restoring the options on the Ladder Printer Tool for PMC
4.1 Changing Menu configuration (Replace the 6.3.3 Menu configuration) 6.3.3 Menu configuration The configuration of menu, which this tool displays, is as follows. (1) Initial menu
File Refer to Fig. 6.3.3.1(b)
Initial menu
View
Tool Bar
Version
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
8/26
View
Tool Bar
Version
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
9/26
(Replace the Fig. 6.3.4.2 [File] menu screen of 6.3.4 Example of basic operation when printing)
4.2 Initial menu (Correct a part of the 6.3.5 Initial menu) [present] 6.3.5 Initial menu The initial menu is a menu displayed in the state immediately after the start of Ladder Printer Tool for PMC or in the state without any program specified. There are three menus of [File], [View], and [Help] in the initial menu. Select [File] to open the program. [correction] 6.3.5 Initial menu The initial menu is a menu displayed in the state immediately after the start of Ladder Printer Tool for PMC or in the state without any program specified. There are three menus of [File], [View], and [Help] in the initial menu. Select [File] to open the program or to save a option file or restore a option file.
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
10/26
Fig. 6.3.5.1(a) [File] menu screen (Insert after the (1) Open Program of 6.3.5.1 File) (2) Save Option File Save the print option setting to a file. The file dialog is displayed as a screen where the file name is selected. Specify the option file name on the file dialog which is displayed. After inputting the option file name which you want to save, click [Save] button. Click [Cancel] button to discontinue saving the print option setting to the file. (3) Restore Option File Restore the print option setting from a file. The file dialog is displayed as a screen where the file name is selected. Specify the option file name on the file dialog which is displayed. After inputting the option file name which you wants to restore, click [Open] button. Click [Cancel] button to discontinue restoring the print option setting from the file.
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
11/26
4.3 Program opening menu (Replace the Fig. 6.3.6.1 [File] menu screen (Program opening) of 6.3.6.1 File )
Fig. 6.3.6.1 [File] menu screen (Program opening) (Insert after the (2) Close Program of 6.3.6.1 File) (3) Save Option File Save the print option setting to a file. The file dialog is displayed as a screen where the file name is selected. Specify the option file name on the file dialog which is displayed. After inputting the option file name which you want to save, click [Save] button. Click [Cancel] button to discontinue saving the print option setting to the file. (4) Restore Option File Restore the print option setting from a file. The file dialog is displayed as a screen where the file name is selected. Specify the option file name on the file dialog which is displayed. After inputting the option file name which you wants to restore, click [Open] button. Click [Cancel] button to discontinue restoring the print option setting from the file.
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
12/26
5.
Print option setting screen on the Ladder Printer Tool for PMC
5.1 Ladder Diagram print (Replace the (1)Ladder Diagram print option screen of 6.3.8.5 Ladder Diagram print) (1) Ladder Diagram print option screen
Fig. 6.3.8.5(a) Ladder Diagram print option screen Details of each item are as follows. [Start Page No.] Group Set page number. [Page No.] Set beginning page numbers of the Ladder Diagram to be printed. An integer value can be set. In default, 1 is set. [Print Title] Group Specify the title and the sub title printed when the frame print is specified. A title and a sub title can be specified up to 60 characters. Specify the title of the Ladder Diagram print. In default, Ladder Diagram is set. Specify the title printed with the Ladder Diagram. Any character string is not set in default.
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
13/26
[Print Range] Group [All] [Net No.] [Page No.] [Print Program] Group [All] [Unit]
Set the range of the print. In default, [All] is checked. All are printed. Specify the range of the net, which you want to print. Specify the range of the page, which you want to print. Set printing Ladder Program. In default, [All] is checked. All are printed. Print specified subprogram. Input the subprogram name which you want to print, or select the subprogram name from combo box.
[Page Feed] Group Specify form feed. [Page Feed(Sub Program)] Specify the presence of form feed for each subprogram. Default is no form feed. [Details] Button Specify a detailed setting of the Ladder Diagram print. The Ladder Diagram detailed setting dialog is displayed when selecting. Refer to (2) Ladder Diagram print option detailed screen for details. Save the print option setting and do preview of the Ladder Diagram. This button is effective when any print item is selected. Save the print option setting and end the print option setting dialog. Discontinue the print option setting and end the print option setting dialog. Refer to help of the Ladder Diagram print option.
[Preview] Button
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
14/26
(Replace the (2)Ladder Diagram print option detailed screen of 6.3.8.5 Ladder Diagram print) (2) Ladder Diagram print option detailed screen
Fig. 6.3.8.5(b) Ladder Diagram print option detailed screen Details of each item are as follows. [Step No./Net No.] group Specify the presence of the step number / net number. [Step No.] Specify the presence of the step number. Default is checked. [Net No.] Specify the presence of the net number. Default is checked. [Line] Group [Narrow] [Wide] [Relay/Coil] Group [Symbol] [Relay Comment] [Cross Reference] Specify the space between lines in the net. In default, [Narrow] is checked. Print the lines of the net with narrow space. Print the lines of the net with wide space. Specify the data printed for each contact. In default, [Symbol] is checked. Print the symbol data of contact. Print the relay comment data of contact. Specify the presence of cross reference. Default is no cross reference.
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
15/26
5.2 Cross Reference print (Replace the (1)Cross Reference print option screen of 6.3.8.9 Cross Reference print) (1) Cross Reference print option screen
Fig. 6.3.8.9(a) Cross Reference print option screen Details of each item are as follows. [Start Page No.] Group Set page number. [Page No.] Set beginning page numbers of the Cross Reference. An integer value can be set. In default, 1 is set. [Print Title] Group Specify the title and the sub title printed when the frame print is specified. A title and a sub title can be specified up to 60 characters. Specify the title of the Cross Reference print. In default, Cross Reference is set. Specify the title of the Cross Reference print. Any character string is not set in default.
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
16/26
[Address Kind]
Set the range of the print. In default, [All] is checked. All are printed. Specify the range of the address, which you want to print. Refer to Table 6.3.8.9(b) for the specification of range. Specify the kind of the address, which you want to print. The plural items can be specified. Set a guidance/sub guidance of the output form. The guidance/sub guidance can be specified up to 19 characters. Set a guidance of the output form. In default, STEP NO./NET NO. is set. Set a sub guidance of the output form. Any character string is not set in default. Specify form feed. Specify the number of line feed inserted between the addresses. A value of 0-9 can be specified. In default, 1 is set. Specify if a form feed is inserted between different kinds of address. Default is checked. Specify a detailed setting for the Cross Reference. The Cross Reference print detailed setting dialog is displayed when selecting. Refer to (2) Cross Reference print option detailed screen for details. Save the print option setting and preview the Cross Reference. This button is effective when any print item is selected. Save the print option setting and end the print option set dialog. Discontinue the print option setting and end the print option set dialog. Refer to help of the Cross Reference print option.
[Print Guidance] Group [Guidance] [Sub Guidance] [Page/Line Feed] Group [Line Feed Count] [Page Feed]
[Details] Button
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
17/26
Table 6.3.8.9(b) Specification of address of Cross Reference print table Address specification Example of key Output address Kind input Bit Address R1.0 Only the specified bit address Byte Address X10 Specified byte address (Contain the bit address) Address F10.0-F12.7 All addresses within the range specification specified range F10.5-F10 To the specified byte address from the specified bit address
(Replace the (2) Cross Reference print option detailed screen of 6.3.8.9 Cross Reference print) (2) Cross Reference print option detailed screen
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
18/26
Details of each item are as follows. [Print Information] Group Set the printed step/net number. [Step No.] Print the step number. Specify it the step number is printed and the first character. [Step No.] is checked in default and [Top Char] is S. [Net No.] Print the net number. Specify it the net number is printed and the first character. [Net No.] is checked in default and [Top Char] is N. [Print No. Type] Set the number print form. In default, Step No./Net No. is set. [Coil Guidance] Group Set the coil guidance. In default, [Ladder Diagram Graphics] is checked. [Ladder Diagram Graphics] Print by the graphic same as the ladder diagram. [User Define String] Print by the character string, which the user defined. The following four can be defined, when [User Define String] is selected. Four all can be specified up to 13 characters. [Read] Specify the character string to indicate the reference by Read contact. In default, Read is set. [Write] Specify the character string to indicate the reference by Write contact. In default, Write is set. [Set] Specify the character string to indicate the reference by Set contact. In default, Set is set. [Reset] Specify the character string to indicate the reference by Reset contact. In default, Reset is set. Specify the printed comment. In default, [Relay Comment] is checked. Print the relay comment. Print the coil comment. Specify whether the checking of writing the coil doubly and the double use of the function instruction is executed. Default is not checked.
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
19/26
5.3 Bit Address Map print (Replace the 6.3.8.10 Bit Address Map print) 6.3.8.10 Bit Address Map print Set the option of the Bit Address Map.
Fig. 6.3.8.10(a) Bit Address Map print option screen Details of each item are as follows. [Start Page No.] Group Set page number. [Page No.] Set beginning page numbers of the Bit Address Map print. An integer value can be set. In default, 1 is set.
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
20/26
Specify the title and the sub title printed when the frame print is specified. A title and a sub title can be specified up to 60 characters. Specify the title of the Bit Address Map print. In default, Bit Address Map is set. Specify the title of the Bit Address Map print. Any character string is not set in default. Set the range of the print. In default, [All] is checked. All are printed. Specify the range of the address, which you want to print. Refer to Table 6.3.8.10(b) for the specification of range. Specify the kind of the address, which you want to print. The plural items can be specified. Print only the address used. Default is checked. Specify form feed. Specify if a form feed is inserted between different kinds of the addresses. Default is checked. Specify the use address mark. An arbitrary sign can be set in the used address mark. Specify one character. In default, @ is set. Specify a detailed setting of the Bit Address Map print. The Bit Address Map print detailed set dialog is displayed when selecting. Refer to 2 Bit Address Map print option detailed screen for details. Save the print option setting and preview the Bit Address Map print. This button is effective when any print item is selected.
[Details] Button
[Preview] Button
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
21/26
Save the print option setting and end the print option set dialog. Discontinue the print option setting and end the print option set dialog. Refer to help of the Bit Address Map print option.
Table 6.3.8.10(b) Specification of address of Bit Address Map print table Address specification Example of key Output address Kind input Bit Address R1.0 Only the specified bit address Byte Address X10 Specified byte address (Contain the bit address) Address F10.0-F12.7 All addresses within Range specification the specified range F10-F20 All addresses within the specified range
6.
Operating environment
(Correct a part of the 2 Operating environment) [present] .... Memory Conventional memory 520 Kbytes or more (Note 2) EMS and/or XMS of 4 Mbytes or more (recommended) (Note 3) .... [correction] .... Memory
Conventional memory 540 Kbytes or more (Note 2) EMS and/or XMS memory 4 Mbytes or more of EMS and/or XMS in total (recommended) (Note 3)
....
(Correct a part of the Note 2 of 2 Operating environment) (Note 2) Even if the computer has 640 Kbytes memory, the free memory may be less than 540 Kbytes when an installed driver, for example, uses a large memory space. The size of free space in memory can be checked with the DOS command CHKDSK or MEM.
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
22/26
(Correct a part of the About size of EMS and XMS memory to be used: of 2 Operating environment) [present] About size of EMS and XMS memory to be used: EMS and XMS memory are used for ladder and symbol & comment data as a temporary area. Although, FAPT LADDER runs with no EMS & XMS, enough size of EMS and/or XMS memory according to the source program to handle will be necessary for better performance. (1) Expansion memory [correction] About size of EMS and XMS memory to be used: EMS and XMS memory are used for ladder, symbol & comment data and On-line Function as a temporary area. A part of function in FAPT LADDER-II dose not run if there is no EMS and/or XMS memory. EMS and/or XMS memory are necessary. Enough size of EMS and/or XMS memory according to the source program to handle will be necessary for better performance. (1) Expansion memory .... .... (4) On-line Function When using On-line function, 1Mbytes or more EMS and/or XMS memory are necessary
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
23/26
7.
(Correct a part of the (2) Symbol & comment specification list of 1.3.2 About Symbol & Comment Data) (Correct a part of the 2.1 Operating environment) [present] (2) Symbol & comment specification list (a) For input signal and internal relay Specification Symbol Available ASCII characters characters (lower-case alphabetic characters not allowed) Maximum cha. 16byte Maximum 20,000 entries (Note) number Duplicated Not allowed definition Display on Yes, if it is 6bytes or CRT/MDI shorter. [correction] (2) Symbol & comment specification list (a) For input signal and internal relay Specification Symbol Available ASCII characters characters (lower-case alphabetic characters and space character are not allowed Maximum cha. 16byte Maximum 20,000 entries (Note) number Duplicated Not allowed definition Display on Yes, if it is 6bytes or CRT/MDI shorter
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
24/26
8.
Config file
(1) When the system is used under WindowsNT4.0 [ The following example shows the case when WindowsNT4.0 is installed in C:\WINNT ] Specify the ANSI.SYS in CONFIG.NT file. The CONFIG.NT file and ANSI.SYS file are usually in the following folder. Check if these file are in the folder. C:\WINNT\SYSTEM32\ Add the following line to CONFIG.NT file by using a text editor. devicehigh=%SystemRoot%\system32\ansi.sys (2) When the system is used under Windows 95 [ The following example shows the case when Windows 95 is installed in C:\WINDOWS ] DEVICE=C:\WINDOWS\ANSI.SYS DEVICE=C:\WINDOWS\EMM386.EXE When the system is used under Windows95, the Japanese input system is not specified in the CONFIG.SYS file. In DOS mode, only the DOS version Japanese input system can be used. The DOS version Japanese input system can be installed by using the ADDDRV command. For details of the installation method, see DOSIME.BAT under the COMMAND director of Windows and DOSIME.SYS under the root directory of the start-up disk. (3)When the system is used under DOS [ The following example shows the case when DOS is already installed in C:\DOS ] DEVICE=C:\DOS\ANSI.SYS DEVICE=C:\DOS\EMM386.EXE DEVICE=C:\DOS\MSIME.SYS DEVICE=C:\DOS\MSIMEK.SYS
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
25/26
[ About device drivers ] a)ANSI.SYS (required) The display mode and attributes of the display unit are set. This setting cannot be omitted. b)EMM386.EXE This device driver enables the use of expansion memory as EMS memory. When using another EMS driver, refer to the relevant manual for details of setting required in CONFIG.SYS. c)MSIME.SYS / MSIMEK.SYS This device driver enables the use of MS-KANJI API for Japanese-language input. When using another Japanese language input system, refer to the relevant manual for details of the setting required in CONFIG.SYS. Notes 1. All of the above device drivers are provided as standard with WindowsNT4.0 / Windows95 / MS-DOS. The specification of switches and parameters may be required for the above settings. For details, refer to the on-line help or the relevant manual for the WindowsNT4.0 / Windows95 / MS-DOS. 2. When using a memory card, refer to the manual provided with the memory card for details of the setting required in CONFIG file. 3. Some device drivers may adversely affect the FAPT LADDER-II. If a problem is anticipated, specify only ANSI.SYS in CONFIG file. Omit the specified, FAPT LADDER-II will support only English, but allows any contention with other device drivers to be identified quickly. Recognized conflicts are listed in Appendix 7.
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.02.26
DATE
Ino
DESIG.
New making
DESCRIPTION
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-6
SHEET
CUST.
26/26
TECHNICAL REPORT
No. TMN99/145E
Summary of Change
New, Add, Correct, Delete Applicable Date
Group
Name/Outline I/O Link expansion (Only for PMC-SB6 for Series 16i /18i /21i) Improvement of partial protection function of ladder program by special password (Only for PMC-SB6(STEP SEQ) for Series 16i /18i /21i)
Basic Function
Add
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.10.15
DATE
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-7
SHEET
CUST.
2/17
Contents
4. The improvement of partial protection function of ladder program by special password _________________________________________________ 8 5. DATA TRANSFER CABLES ________________________________________________ 15
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.10.15
DATE
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-7
SHEET
CUST.
3/17
1.
The following function of FAPT LADDER-II has been added. - I/O Link expansion - Improvement of partial protect funciotn of ladder program by special password This manual is a supplementary manual for these additional functions. Other explanation (existing functions and operation,etc.) are described in the following manual. Name of Manual Spec.No. Reference Items FAPT LADDER-II BOperation for OPERATOR'S MANUAL 66184EN FAPT LADDER-II
Outline
2.
The additional functions described herein apply to the following software. FAPT LADDER-II (1) I/O Link expansion Name Specification Version FAPT LADDER-II A08B-9201-J503 04.0 or later (2) Improvement of partial protection function of ladder program by special password Name Specification Version FAPT LADDER-II A08B-9201-J503 03.3 or later PMC Control Software (for Series 16i /18i /21i ) (1) I/O Link expansion Software Series PMC-SB5/SB6 control software 406A
Applied Software
Version 15 or later
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.10.15
DATE
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-7
SHEET
CUST.
4/17
3.
3.1 The number of I/O Link channel (Insert after the (3) Specifying the direction for online communication in "4.4.1 Program selection") (4) Specifying the number of I/O Link channel When models in which more than two channels can be set is selected, the following menu is displayed.
In this menu., it selects the number of I/O Link channel. (When model is PMC-QC this menu is not displayed, because PMC-QC always has two channels.)
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.10.15
DATE
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-7
SHEET
CUST.
5/17
3.2 Mnemonic Editing (Correct a part of the PMC-PA3/RA1/RA3/RA5/RB4/RB5/RB6 "4.5.8.4 Sample mnemonic files (single-format) (a)Parameter") [present] %@0 PMC- PA3/RA1/RA3/RA5/RB4/RB5/RB6 2 BINARY 2.Counter data type (BINARY or BCD) 3 NO 3.Whether an operator's panel (YES:Used,NO:Not used) 4 PMC-RB4 4.PMC model (PMC-PA3/PMC-RA1/PMC-RA3/ PMC% RA5/ [EOB] PMC-RB4/PMC-RB4(STEP SEQ)/ PMC-RB5/ PMC-RB6/PMC-RB6(STEP SEQ))
[correction] PMC- PA3/RA1/RA3/RA5/RB4/RB5/RB6 %@0 2 BINARY 3 NO 4 PMC-RB4 % [EOB] 2.Counter data type (BINARY or BCD) 3.Whether an operator's panel (YES:Used,NO:Not used) 4.PMC model (PMC-PA3/PMC-RA1/PMC-RA3/ PMCRA5/ PMC-RB4/PMC-RB4(STEP SEQ)/ PMC-RB5/ PMC-RB6/PMC-RB6(STEP SEQ)/ PMC-RB6(IO-2)/PMC-RB6(STEP,IO-2))
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.10.15
DATE
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-7
SHEET
CUST.
6/17
(Add to the "[Setting data table to "PMC model" parametereach PMC model] " of "4.5.8.4 Sample mnemonic files(single-format) (a)Parameter ") [present] PMC model PMC-SA1 PMC-SA3 PMC-SA5 PMC-SB3 PMC-SB4 PMC-SB4(STEP SEQ) PMC-SB5 PMC-SB6 PMC-SB6(STEP SEQ) PMC-SC3 PMC-SC4 PMC-SC4(STEP SEQ) PMC-NB PMC-NB2 PMC-PA3 PMC-QC [correcting] PMC model PMC-SA1 PMC-SA3 PMC-SA5 PMC-SB3 PMC-SB4 PMC-SB4(STEP SEQ) PMC-SB5 PMC-SB6 PMC-SB6(STEP SEQ) PMC-SB6(IO-2) PMC-SB6(STEP,IO-2) PMC-SC3 PMC-SC4 PMC-SC4(STEP SEQ) PMC-NB PMC-NB2 PMC-NB6 PMC-PA3 PMC-QC
Setting data (Normal-width character string) PMC-RA1 PMC-RA3 PMC-RA5 PMC-RB3 PMC-RB4 PMC-RB4(STEP SEQ) PMC-RB5 PMC-RB6 PMC-RB6(STEP SEQ) PMC-RC3 PMC-RC4 PMC-RC4(STEP SEQ) PMC-NB PMC-NB2 PMC-PA3 PMC-QC
Setting data (Normal-width character string) PMC-RA1 PMC-RA3 PMC-RA5 PMC-RB3 PMC-RB4 PMC-RB4(STEP SEQ) PMC-RB5 PMC-RB6 PMC-RB6(STEP SEQ) PMC-RB6(IO-2) PMC-RB6(STEP,IO-2) PMC-RC3 PMC-RC4 PMC-RC4(STEP SEQ) PMC-NB PMC-NB2 PMC-NB6 PMC-PA3 PMC-QC
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.10.15
DATE
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-7
SHEET
CUST.
7/17
4.
(Replace the 4.5.4.3 Password set function) 4.5.4.3 Password set function This function is supported only in the series 15-B/16/18/21-B, Series 16/18/21-C, Power Mate-H, Series 15i, Series 16i /18i /21i A, and Power Mate i D/H. It enables a password to be added during compilation. The password can be used to prohibit ladder programs from being displayed or edited on the CTR/MDI. This function requires to be set the program option. (Refer to 4.5.7 Setting program options.) (1) Password (a)Password types Type Password(R) Password (R/W)
Use Password to allow display on the CNC Password to allow display and editing on the CNC
(b)Password setting(compile) 1 When no password Go to . When password RW&R,RW,R After compilation [EXEC] or [CONDNS] is selected, you will be prompted to specify whetherto use a password. Do you enter password ?(Y/N) To set a password, press Y password RW&R or R go to. It is unnecessary to set a password, press N password RW go to . 2 The password set screen appears. Enter password (R) 3 Enter a password A password that can be used is a combination of 8 or less letters and/or numerals. Uppercase and lowercase letters are not distinguished from each other.(If a lowercase letter is entered, it is assumed to be uppercase.) It is impossible to use space, kana, kanji, and special characters (such as *,#,and @).
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.10.15
DATE
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-7
SHEET
CUST.
8/17
Some character strings are unusable. If one such character string is entered as a password, an error message is displayed. In such a case, use another character string. An entered password is not displayed on the screen. If the <Enter> key is pressed before any valid password is specified, use of a password is not specified. If password=RW&R go to . If password=R go to . When <Esc> is pressed, an attempt to specify a password is discontinued go to . 4 The password configuration screen appears. Verification(R) 5 You will be prompted to enter the same password as entered before, to ensure that your password was entered correctly. When the password entered this time matches one that was entered before, it is accepted When they do not match, the message Password mismatch is displayed. You are allowed to retry entering twice. When <Esc> is pressed, an attempt to specify a password is discontinued go to . If password=R is specified. go to . The password(R/W) set screen appears. Enter password (R/W) Enter a password(R/W). A password that can be used is a combination of 8 or less letters and/or numerals. Uppercase and lowercase letters are not distinguished from each other.(If a lowercase letter is entered, it is assumed to be uppercase.) It is impossible to use space, kana, kanji, and special characters (such as *,#,and @). Some character strings are unusable. If one such character string is entered as a password, an error message is displayed. In such a case, use another character string. An entered password is not displayed on the screen. If the <Enter> key is pressed before any valid password is specified, use of a password is not specified. go to . When <Esc> is pressed, an attempt to specify a password is discontinued go to . The password confirmation screen appears. Verification(R/W)
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.10.15
DATE
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-7
SHEET
CUST.
9/17
You will be prompted to enter the same password as entered before, to ensure that your password was entered correctly. When the password entered this time matches one that was entered before, it is accepted When they do not match, the message Password mismatch is displayed. You are allowed to retry entering twice. When <Esc> is pressed, an attempt to specify a password is discontinued go to . Compilation begins.
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.10.15
DATE
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-7
SHEET
CUST.
10/17
(2)Special password (a)Partial protecting function Partial protection of a ladder program can be done by dividing the subprogram area into the protected area and the non-protected area by using a special password. Protected area : Inputting password is necessary to display and edit a ladder program on CRT/MDI. Non-protected area : To display and edit on CRT/MDI are permitted without inputting password. (b)Applied PMC models This function can be used by following PMCs with step sequence function. PMC-RB4(STEP)/RC4(STEP) /RB6(STEP)/RB6(STEP,IO-2)/NB2(STEP) (c)Protected area / Non-protected area The protected area and the non-protected area are decided according to the subprogram number. Refer to the following for details. Main-program LEVEL1 LEVEL2 LEVEL3 Subprogram P1P1499 P1500P2000 Protected Protected Protected Protected Non-Protected
(d)Setting of password The password(R/W) which starts with "#" is to be set. Example) #FANUC For the operation to set the special password, refer to "(1) Password (b)Password setting(compile)" because it is similar to a normal password.
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.10.15
DATE
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-7
SHEET
CUST.
11/17
(Replace the 4.5.5.3 Password) 4.5.5.3 Password (1)Password To decompile a password-protected file, it is necessary to enter a password. Set password type Both password(R) and password(R/W) Password(R/W) Password (R) Password type to be entered Password (R/W) Password (R/W) Password (R)
After the discompilation [EXEC] is selected, the following password entry screen appears. Enter password(R) Note) If an R/W password has been set up, Password(R/W) is displayed. When the valid password is entered, discompilation begins. If the newly entered password is incorrect, an error message is displayed, and processing discontinues.(You are allowed to retry entering twice.) When <Esc> is pressed, the request to start discompilation is rejected. (2)Special password There are two ways of decompilations of an object file with a special password as follows. (a)Decompilation of all programs (Necessary a special password input) The procedure of a decompilation is similar to that of an object protected by a 'non-special' password. Refer to "(1)password". (b)Decompilation of non-protected subprograms area only (Not necessary a special password input) In OFF-LINE FUNCTION, it is possible to edit only non-protected subprograms area, (A printout is also possible. But it is impossible to convert to a mnemonic file because a source program of a protected area is not created.) Re-compilation after modifying of non-protected area is possible. But the password set function is disabled. A special password in a decompiled object file is automatically embedded and the protected area is re-protected.
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.10.15
DATE
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-7
SHEET
CUST.
12/17
The decompilation procedure is as follows. i) Select [EXEC] for a decompilation. a password input screen is displayed. Enter password (R/W) ii)To decompile only subprograms of non-protected area, press <Enter> key without entering a password. To cancel a decompilation, press <Esc> key.
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.10.15
DATE
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-7
SHEET
CUST.
13/17
(Correct a part of the 4.5.7.1 Compile (4) Password in "4.5.7 Setting program options") [present] (4) Password This option specifies whether to display the password setting dialog box at compil time. [NO] [RW&R] [RW] [R] : Does not display the dialog box.(Password setting is disabled.) : Displays the password (R/W) setting dialog box as well as the password (R) setting dialog box. : Displays only the password (R/W) setting dialog box. : Displays only the password (R) setting dialog box.
[correcting] (4) Password This option specifies whether to display the password setting dialog box at compil time. [NO] [RW&R] [RW] [R] : Does not display the dialog box.(Password setting is disabled.) : Displays the password (R/W) setting dialog box as well as the password (R) setting dialog box. : Displays only the password (R/W) setting dialog box. : Displays only the password (R) setting dialog box.
Note) Password setting is disabled when only a non-protected subprograms area of an object file with a special password has been decompiled. To enable a password setting, please decompile all programs with a special password input . (Please refer to (2) Special password in 4.5.5.3 Password)
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.10.15
DATE
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-7
SHEET
CUST.
14/17
5.
Replace APPENDIX 8 DATA TRANSFER CABLES APPENDIX 8 DATA TRANSFER CABLE Use the cables below to transfer data from PC to a CNC, P-G(P-G Mark II or P-G Mate), or ROM writer(FA writer or PMC writer). 1. For IBM PC/AT (1)
A02B-02008 IBM PC/AT CNC / P-G / ROM writer
9-pin female t
CD(1) RD(2) SD(3) ER(4) SG(5) DR(6) RS(7) CS(8) (2)SD (3)RD (6)DR (7)SG (8)CD (5)CS (4)RS (20)ER
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.10.15
DATE
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-7
SHEET
CUST.
15/17
IBM PC/AT
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.10.15
DATE
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-7
SHEET
CUST.
16/17
IBM PS/2
TITLE
01
EDIT
99.10.15
DATE
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-7
SHEET
CUST.
17/17
TECHNICAL REPORT
IDE
Summary of Change
New, Add, Correct, Delete Add Applicable Date Jun. 2000 or later
Group
Name/Outline
Basic Function Optional Function Unit Maintenance Parts Notice Correction Another
TITLE
01
00.06.26
Newly Registration.
MANUAL
DRAW.NO.
B-66184EN/02-8
SHEET
CUST.
EDIT
DATE
DESIG.
DESCRIPTION
1/9
Contents
1. Outline ____________________________________________________________________3 2. Applied Software___________________________________________________________3 3. Setting Program Options ___________________________________________________4 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 Menu Display __________________________________________________________ 4 Compile _______________________________________________________________ 4 Mnemonic Editing______________________________________________________ 6 Modifying Program Option Initial Values(OPTION.CNF) __________________ 6
4. Symbol & Comment Editing _______________________________________________8 5. Conversion of a Mnemonic File to a Source Program ________________________9
TITLE
B-66184EN/02-8
SHEET
EDIT
DATE
DESIG.
DESCRIPTION
2/9
1.
Outline
The following function of FAPT LADDER-II has been added. Improvement of program option setting. This manual is a supplementary manual for these additional functions. Other explanation (existing functions and operation,etc.) are described in the following manual. Name of Manual FAPT LADDER-II OPERATOR'S MANUAL Spec.No. B-66184EN Reference Items Operation for FAPT LADDER-II
2.
Applied Software
The additional functions described here in apply to the following software. Name FAPT LADDER-II Specification A08B-9201-J503 Version 04.4 or later
TITLE
B-66184EN/02-8
SHEET
EDIT
DATE
DESIG.
DESCRIPTION
3/9
Compile Decompile
Mnemonic edit
10
3.2 Compile (Add to since item (4) paragraph of [4.5.7.1 Compile]) (5) sym. ( too long strings ) When you compile the source program which contains the symbol which exceeds six characters. How to treat the input signal and the internal relay address is specified. [ ERROR ] The symbol comment that exceeds six characters in length is considered to be an error, and the compiler is not compiled. (Specification in the past) [ IGNORE] The symbol comment that exceeds six characters in length is replaced with six characters' worth of a space code and compiled.
TITLE
B-66184EN/02-8
SHEET
EDIT
DATE
DESIG.
DESCRIPTION
4/9
(6) Coil comment language When you compile the source program. The form by which the coil comment is output to the object file is specified. [ English ] The Japanese coil comment is replaced with space and the compiler is output to the object file. [ Japanese] The Japanese coil comment is converted into the code data and the compiler is output to the object file. (Changing of Figure 4.5.7.1 in [ 4.5.7.1 Compile])
[ Compile ] condense symbol/comment sym.( too long strings ) net comment password multiple used check Coil comment language
2 3 4 5 6
Note 1) A past "Symbol" item changed the name to "Symbol & coil comment". Note 2) When the parameter of "Symbol/Comment" is assumed "ON", setting the parameter of "sym. ( too long strings )" becomes possible. Note3) Japanese is not displayed on the NC side as for setting the coil comments language, and set "English" mode, please.
TITLE
B-66184EN/02-8
SHEET
EDIT
DATE
DESIG.
DESCRIPTION
5/9
3.3 Mnemonic Editing (Changing of Item 4.5.7.3 in [ 4.5.7.3 Mnemonic Editing]) The thing to choose Mnemonic edit from the menu screen displays the option of a mnemonic edit. (1) Warning detail out The method of outputting the warning when convert from a mnemonic file to the source file is specified. (Warning number K:W-4131, K:W-4133, and K:W-4139) [NO] Conversion from the mnemonic of symbol & comment to the source ends. The generated warning and the frequency are output. [YES] The warning is output in the location where the warning is generated while converting from the mnemonic of symbol & comment to the source. (Specification in the past) Program option set-up
C:\DATA\SAMPLE
10
Fig. 4.5.7.3
TITLE
B-66184EN/02-8
SHEET
EDIT
DATE
DESIG.
DESCRIPTION
6/9
3.4 Modifying Program Option Initial Values (OPTION.CNF) (The item number of "4.5.7.3 Modifying Program Option Initial Values (OPTION.CNF)" is changed to "4.5.7.4") (The item number of "Table 4.5.7.3" is changed to "4.5.7.4", and the following option items are added)
Subsection *COMPAILE Option Comment_lang Setting and function 0: The em-size character of the coil comment is replaced with space so far and output to the object file. 1: The em-size character of the coil comment is output to the object file by the code. Symbol_over The address, which includes the symbol that exceeds six characters, is not compiled. 1: Address is compiled after the symbol, which exceeds six characters, is converted into the space code. 0: When conversion into the source ends, the warning is output. 1: Warning is outputs at each warning generation. 0:
*MNEMONIC
Warning_full
TITLE
B-66184EN/02-8
SHEET
EDIT
DATE
DESIG.
DESCRIPTION
7/9
(1) When setting the option "sym.( too long strings )"is made "ERROR". Display at : SYMBOL 000002 000006 COIL_COMMENT 00000060 00000180 (2) When setting the option "sym.( too long strings )"is made "IGNORE". Display at : SYMBOL 000002 000006 COIL_COMMENT 00000180 00000180
TITLE
B-66184EN/02-8
SHEET
EDIT
DATE
DESIG.
DESCRIPTION
8/9
Notes: When the coil comment which includes the alphabetic small letter of normal-width made in the form of format A or B converts a mnemonic file into the source program, an alphabetic small letter is replaced with the capital letter.
6. Warning
Addition to the item of 5.9.3 Warning of "5. ERROR MESSAGE LIST".
Number I:W-4503
Message $ : The character * in the comment may not be displayed on the CNC. $ : Double-sized space character in comment was changed to two singlesized spaces. Too long strings for symbol data.
Contents Because the character of no character code in CNC is used to comment, the character might not be able to be displayed. Because the em-size space code was used to comment, the em-size space code is replaced with the normal-width space code (two characters). Because the symbol data exceeded the limitation of the number of characters, the symbol is deleted. (Comment is effective)
I:W-4504
I:W-4505
TITLE
B-66184EN/02-8
SHEET
EDIT
DATE
DESIG.
DESCRIPTION
9/9